1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname
\endcsname\relax\input plain
\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2015-
10-
29.16}
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015
11 % Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
14 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
15 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
16 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
18 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
19 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
20 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
21 % General Public License for more details.
23 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
24 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
26 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
27 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
28 % restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
29 % of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
32 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
33 % http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
34 % http://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
35 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
57 % full Texinfo distribution.
59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
62 \message{Loading texinfo
[version
\texinfoversion]:
}
64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
66 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version
\texinfoversion]}%
68 \catcode`+=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active}
72 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
73 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
76 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
78 \let\ptexbullet=
\bullet
86 \let\ptexfootnote=
\footnote
90 \let\ptexindent=
\indent
91 \let\ptexinsert=
\insert
94 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
95 \let\ptexnoindent=
\noindent
97 \let\ptexraggedright=
\raggedright
105 {\catcode`\'=
\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'
}% active in plain's math mode
107 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
108 % starts a new line in the output.
111 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
112 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
114 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
115 \let\linenumber =
\empty % Pre-3.0.
117 \def\linenumber{l.
\the\inputlineno:
\space}
120 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
121 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix
}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter
}\fi
123 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error
}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file
}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in
}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)
}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)
}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info
}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of
}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on
}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title
}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of
}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on
}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page
}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section
}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section
}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see
}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See
}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents
}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents
}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January
}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February
}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March
}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April
}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May
}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June
}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July
}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August
}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September
}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October
}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November
}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December
}\fi
155 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro
}\fi
156 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form
}\fi
157 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable
}\fi
158 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option
}\fi
159 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function
}\fi
161 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
162 \chardef\spacecat =
10
163 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =
\spacecat}
165 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
166 \chardef\ampChar = `\&
167 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
168 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
169 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
170 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
171 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
172 \chardef\hashChar = `\#
173 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
174 \chardef\questChar = `\?
175 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
176 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
177 \chardef\slashChar = `\/
178 \chardef\underChar = `
\_
184 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
185 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
189 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
190 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
191 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
192 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
193 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
195 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
196 wide-spread wrap-around
199 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
200 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
201 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
202 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
203 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
205 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs =
1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
209 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
214 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
215 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
222 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
226 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
227 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
230 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
231 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
233 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
234 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
236 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\smallskipamount
237 \removelastskip\penalty-
50\smallskip\fi\fi}
238 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\medskipamount
239 \removelastskip\penalty-
100\medskip\fi\fi}
240 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\bigskipamount
241 \removelastskip\penalty-
200\bigskip\fi\fi}
246 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
247 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
248 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
250 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=
0pt
}
252 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
255 \let\cropmarks =
\cropmarkstrue
257 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
258 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
260 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
261 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=
1pc
262 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=
.3pt
263 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=
.75in
265 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
266 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
267 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
269 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
270 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
272 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
273 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
274 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
275 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
276 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
277 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
280 \toks0=
\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
281 \toks2=
\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
282 \toks4=
\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
283 \toks6=
\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
284 \toks8=
\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
286 \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: top marks (\last...)
287 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: bottom marks (default, \prev...)
288 \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
292 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks - extract needed part of mark.
294 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
295 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
296 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
297 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
299 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
301 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
303 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
304 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
306 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
307 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
308 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
310 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
311 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
314 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
315 \newdimen\bindingoffset
316 \newdimen\normaloffset
317 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
319 % Main output routine.
322 \output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
327 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.
328 % \shipout a vbox for a single page, adding an optional header, footer,
329 % cropmarks, and footnote. This also causes index entries for this page
330 % to be written to the auxiliary files.
333 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=
0pt
\else \hoffset=
\normaloffset \fi
335 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by
\bindingoffset
336 \else \advance\hoffset by -
\bindingoffset\fi
338 % Common context changes for both heading and footing.
339 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
340 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
341 \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=
\pagewidth \texinfochars}
343 % Retrieve the information for the headings from the marks in the page,
344 % and call Plain TeX's \makeheadline and \makefootline, which use the
345 % values in \headline and \footline.
347 % This is used to check if we are on the first page of a chapter.
349 \ifx\thischapter\empty
350 % See comment for \gettopheadingmarks
351 \ifcase0\firstmark\fi
352 \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
353 \ifcase1\firstmark\fi
354 \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
356 \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
358 \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
361 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
362 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
364 \ifx\curchaptername\prevchaptername
366 % If on the first page of a chapter, clear @thischapter so it
367 % doesn't appear in the headline, because the chapter is already
368 % shown in the chapter heading.
372 \global\setbox\headlinebox =
\vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
373 \global\setbox\footlinebox =
\vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}%
376 % Set context for writing to auxiliary files like index files.
377 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
378 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
379 % before the \shipout runs.
381 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
382 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
383 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
384 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
385 % \entry{{\indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
386 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
388 % {\code {{\backslashcurfont }acronym}
390 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
391 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name
{\the\pageno} xyz
\fi
393 \ifcropmarks \vbox to
\outervsize\bgroup
395 \vskip-
\topandbottommargin
397 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
400 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
402 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
405 \vskip\topandbottommargin
407 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
408 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
414 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox >
0pt
415 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
416 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
417 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
423 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
424 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
425 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
426 \boxmaxdepth =
\cornerthick
429 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
431 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
434 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
436 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
438 }% end of \shipout\vbox
439 }% end of group with \indexdummies
441 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-
20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
444 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=
\maxdimen
446 % Main part of page, including any footnotes
447 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to
\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=
\maxdepth #1}}
449 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
450 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
451 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
452 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to
\z@
{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
453 \dimen@=
\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
454 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
455 \ifr@ggedbottom
\kern-
\dimen@
\vfil \fi}
458 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
459 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
460 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
462 \def\ewtop{\vrule height
\cornerthick depth0pt width
\cornerlong}
464 {\hrule height
\cornerthick depth
\cornerlong width
\cornerthick}}
465 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerlong}
467 {\hrule height
\cornerlong depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerthick}}
472 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
473 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
474 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
475 % For example, \def\foo{\parsearg\fooxxx}.
477 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
478 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
484 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
488 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M
{%
489 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
490 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
494 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. Also remove a @texinfoc
495 % comment (see \scanmacro for details). Pass the result on to \argcheckspaces.
496 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
497 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argremovetexinfoc #1\texinfoc\ArgTerm}
498 \def\argremovetexinfoc#1\texinfoc#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
\ArgTerm}
500 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
502 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
503 % @end itemize @c foo
504 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
505 % by \finishparsearg.
507 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M
}
508 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M
{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
}
509 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
#2\^^M
#3\ArgTerm{%
512 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
513 \let\temp\finishparsearg
515 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
517 % Put the space token in:
521 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
522 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
523 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
524 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
525 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
526 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
527 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
529 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
531 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
534 % \parseargdef - define a command taking an argument on the line
536 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
537 % is roughly equivalent to
538 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
541 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
543 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
548 % Several utility definitions with active space:
553 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
554 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
555 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
556 % should produce a line of output anyway.
558 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =
\tie}
560 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
561 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
562 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
563 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =
\space}
567 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next#
#1{}\else \let\next=
\relax \fi \next}
569 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
574 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
575 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
576 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
577 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
578 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
580 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
581 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
582 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
586 % At run-time, environments start with this:
587 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
591 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
592 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
593 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
595 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
604 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
607 \errmessage{This command can appear only
\inenvironment\temp,
608 not
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
610 \def\inenvironment#1{%
612 outside of any environment
%
614 in environment
\expandafter\string#1%
618 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
619 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
622 \if 1\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname
624 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
625 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
626 \csname E
#1\endcsname
631 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.
}
634 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
635 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
636 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
637 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
638 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
640 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
641 % if the definition is written into an index file.
642 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
643 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\
}
646 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
647 \def\:
{\spacefactor=
1000 }
649 % @* forces a line break.
650 \def\*
{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
652 % @/ allows a line break.
655 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
656 \def\.
{.
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
658 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
659 \def\!
{!
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
661 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
662 \def\?
{?
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
664 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
669 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
671 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
672 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
675 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `
\temp', must be on|off
}%
679 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
680 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
681 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
682 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
684 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
685 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
686 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
687 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
688 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
689 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
690 % the text is small, which looks bad.
692 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
693 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
694 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
695 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
696 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
697 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
703 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=
\active \else
704 \errhelp =
\groupinvalidhelp
705 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled
}%
709 \setbox\groupbox =
\vtop\bgroup
710 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
711 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
712 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
713 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
714 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
715 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
719 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
720 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
721 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
722 % above. But it's pretty close.
724 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
725 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
726 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
727 \global\dimen1 =
\prevdepth
728 \egroup % End the \vtop.
735 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
736 \dimen0 =
\ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by
\dp\groupbox
737 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
738 \dimen2 =
\pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -
\pagetotal
739 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
740 % group, force a page break.
741 \ifdim \dimen0 >
\dimen2
742 \ifdim \pagetotal <
\vfilllimit\pageheight
750 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
751 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
753 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
754 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J
%
755 where each line of input produces a line of output.
}
757 % @need space-in-mils
758 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
760 \newdimen\mil \mil=
0.001in
763 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
767 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
769 \dimen2 =
\ht\strutbox
770 \advance\dimen2 by
\dp\strutbox
771 \ifdim\dimen0 >
\dimen2
773 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
774 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
775 % And a page break here is fine.
776 \vtop to
#1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
778 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
779 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
780 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
781 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
782 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
784 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
785 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
786 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
787 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
788 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
789 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
790 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
793 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
796 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
801 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
805 % @page forces the start of a new page.
807 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
810 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
812 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
813 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
814 \newskip\exdentamount
816 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
817 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -
\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
819 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
820 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -
\exdentamount
821 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
823 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
824 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
825 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
827 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=
1cm
828 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
830 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
833 \vtop to
\strutdepth{%
834 \baselineskip=
\strutdepth
836 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
837 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
839 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
841 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
846 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l
}
847 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r
}
849 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
850 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
851 % else use TEXT for both).
853 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,
\finish}
854 \def\parseinmargin#1,
#2,
#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
855 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
857 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
860 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
865 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
867 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
872 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
873 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
874 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
875 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
876 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). This command
877 % is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work.
880 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
883 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
885 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
886 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
889 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
890 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
893 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
894 \vrule height
\baselineskip width1pt
896 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
902 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
904 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
909 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
910 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
911 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
912 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of
#1^^J
}%
913 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
915 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
921 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
935 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
936 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
938 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
939 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
941 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
942 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
945 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
946 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
947 the stack of filenames is empty.
}}
952 % outputs that line, centered.
954 \parseargdef\center{%
956 \let\centersub\centerH
958 \let\centersub\centerV
960 \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
961 \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
965 \advance\hsize by -
\leftskip
966 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
971 \newcount\centerpenalty
973 % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
974 % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
975 % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
976 % prevent a page break here.
977 \centerpenalty =
\lastpenalty
978 \ifnum\centerpenalty>
10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
979 \ifnum\centerpenalty>
9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
980 \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
983 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
985 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
987 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
988 % @c is the same as @comment
989 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
991 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=
\active%
992 \catcode`\@=
\other \catcode`\
{=
\other \catcode`\
}=
\other\commentxxx}%
994 {\catcode`\^^M=
\active%
995 \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M
{\endgroup%
996 \futurelet\nexttoken\commentxxxx}%
997 \gdef\commentxxxx{\ifx\nexttoken\aftermacro\expandafter\comment\fi}%
1000 \def\c{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=
\active%
1001 \catcode`\@=
\other \catcode`\
{=
\other \catcode`\
}=
\other%
1003 {\catcode`\^^M=
\active \gdef\cxxx#1^^M
{\endgroup}}
1004 % See comment in \scanmacro about why the definitions of @c and @comment differ
1006 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
1007 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
1008 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
1009 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
1011 \def\asisword{asis
} % no translation, these are keywords
1014 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
1019 \defaultparindent =
0pt
1021 \defaultparindent =
#1em
1024 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
1027 % @exampleindent NCHARS
1028 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
1029 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
1030 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
1031 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
1036 \lispnarrowing =
0pt
1038 \lispnarrowing =
#1em
1043 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
1044 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
1045 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
1048 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
1049 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
1050 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
1051 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1053 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1054 \def\insertword{insert
}
1056 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1059 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1060 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1061 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\relax
1063 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
1064 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `
\temp'
}%
1068 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1069 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1071 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1074 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1075 \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
1076 \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
1077 \global\everypar =
{\kern -
\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
1080 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1081 \global\let\indent =
\ptexindent
1082 \global\let\noindent =
\ptexnoindent
1083 \global\everypar =
{}%
1087 % @refill is a no-op.
1090 % @setfilename INFO-FILENAME - ignored
1091 \let\setfilename=
\comment
1094 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=
1\ptexend}
1098 % adobe `portable' document format
1102 \newcount\filenamelength
1112 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1114 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1115 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
1116 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
1118 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1127 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1128 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1129 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1130 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1132 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
1133 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
1134 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1135 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
1136 % do this reliably, so we use it.
1138 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
1140 \def\txiescapepdf#1{%
1141 \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
1142 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
1143 % Many times it won't matter.
1145 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
1146 % backslashes, and other special chars.
1147 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
1151 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1152 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1153 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1158 % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
1159 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
1160 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
1161 % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
1162 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
1163 % black by default, though.
1164 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1165 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1167 % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1168 % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1169 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg
#1 RG
}}
1171 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1172 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1174 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1179 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1180 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1181 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1182 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1186 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1194 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1196 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1197 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1205 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines
}
1207 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1208 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1209 \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1210 \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1212 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1213 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1214 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1216 \let\pdfimgext=
\empty
1218 \openin 1 #1.pdf
\ifeof 1
1219 \openin 1 #1.PDF
\ifeof 1
1220 \openin 1 #1.png
\ifeof 1
1221 \openin 1 #1.jpg
\ifeof 1
1222 \openin 1 #1.jpeg
\ifeof 1
1223 \openin 1 #1.JPG
\ifeof 1
1224 \errhelp =
\nopdfimagehelp
1225 \errmessage{Could not find image file
#1 for pdf
}%
1226 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG
}%
1228 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg
}%
1230 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg
}%
1232 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png
}%
1234 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF
}%
1236 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf
}%
1241 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1242 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1243 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1246 \immediate\pdfximage
1248 \ifdim \wd0 >
0pt width
\pdfimagewidth \fi
1249 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt height
\pdfimageheight \fi
1250 \ifnum\pdftexversion<
13
1255 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14 \else
1256 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1260 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1261 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1264 \makevalueexpandable
1265 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1266 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1267 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name
{\pdfdestname} xyz
}%
1270 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1273 % by default, use black for everything.
1274 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1275 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1276 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1278 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1279 % come from Petr Olsak
1280 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1281 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1282 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=
\expnumber{#1}\relax
1283 \advance\tempnum by
1
1284 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1286 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1287 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1288 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1289 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1290 % #4 is the page number
1292 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1293 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1294 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1295 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1296 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1297 \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1298 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1299 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1301 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest
1304 % Also escape PDF chars in the display string.
1305 \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1306 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
1308 \pdfoutline goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1311 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1313 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1314 \def\partentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1315 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1316 \def\thischapnum{#
#2}%
1318 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1320 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1321 \advancenumber{chap
\thischapnum}%
1322 \def\thissecnum{#
#2}%
1323 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1325 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1326 \advancenumber{sec
\thissecnum}%
1327 \def\thissubsecnum{#
#2}%
1329 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1330 \advancenumber{subsec
\thissubsecnum}%
1332 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1334 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1336 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1337 % al. a second time, below.
1338 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1339 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1340 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1341 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1342 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1343 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1344 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1345 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1348 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1349 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1350 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1352 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1353 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1354 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{chap#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1355 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1356 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{sec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1357 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1358 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{subsec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1359 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{% count is always zero
1360 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1362 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1363 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1364 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1365 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1366 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1368 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1369 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
1370 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
1371 % we use for the index sort strings.
1375 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1376 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1377 \def\
{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1378 \def\
}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1379 \catcode`\\=
\active \otherbackslash
1380 \input \tocreadfilename
1383 {\catcode`
[=
1 \catcode`
]=
2
1384 \catcode`
{=
\other \catcode`
}=
\other
1385 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1386 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1389 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|
}%
1390 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1391 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1392 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1393 \advance\filenamelength by
1
1396 \def\getfilename#1{%
1398 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1399 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1401 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|
\relax
1403 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1404 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1406 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1408 % make a live url in pdf output.
1411 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1412 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1413 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1414 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1416 \normalturnoffactive
1419 \let\xprocessmacroarg=
\eatspaces % in case we are in a macro expansion
1420 \makevalueexpandable
1421 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1422 % special-casing \var here?
1425 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1426 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
1427 user
{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (
#1) >>
}%
1429 \def\pdfgettoks#1.
{\setbox\boxA=
\hbox{\toksA=
{#1.
}\toksB=
{}\maketoks}}
1430 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1=
{\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1431 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=
1\let\next=
\maketoks}
1432 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|
{\let\first=
#1\toksD=
{#1}\toksA=
{#2}}
1434 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|
\relax
1436 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1437 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1438 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1440 \ifnum0=
\countA\else\makelink\fi
1441 \ifx\first.
\let\next=
\done\else
1443 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1444 \ifx\first,
\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1446 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1448 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1449 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC=
{}\global\countA=
0}
1451 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]} goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1452 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1453 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA=
{\the\toksB}}\st}
1456 \let\pdfmkdest =
\gobble
1457 \let\pdfurl =
\gobble
1458 \let\endlink =
\relax
1459 \let\setcolor =
\gobble
1460 \let\pdfsetcolor =
\gobble
1461 \let\pdfmakeoutlines =
\relax
1462 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1467 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1468 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1469 % italics, not bold italics.
1471 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1472 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1473 \csname ten
#1\endcsname % change the current font
1476 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1478 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts
\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1480 \def\rm{\fam=
0 \setfontstyle{rm
}}
1481 \def\it{\fam=
\itfam \setfontstyle{it
}}
1482 \def\sl{\fam=
\slfam \setfontstyle{sl
}}
1483 \def\bf{\fam=
\bffam \setfontstyle{bf
}}\def\bfstylename{bf
}
1484 \def\tt{\fam=
\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt
}}
1486 % Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since
1487 % in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh.
1488 \def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf
}}
1490 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1491 % So we set up a \sf.
1493 \def\sf{\fam=
\sffam \setfontstyle{sf
}}
1494 \let\li =
\sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1496 % We don't need math for this font style.
1497 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl
}}
1500 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1501 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1502 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1504 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1505 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1506 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1508 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1509 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1511 \newdimen\textleading
1514 \normalbaselineskip =
\baselinefactor\dimen0
1515 \normallineskip =
\lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1517 \setbox\strutbox =
\hbox{%
1518 \vrule width0pt height
\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1519 depth
\strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1523 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1525 % do nothing with this by default.
1526 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname\gobble
1527 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname\gobble
1528 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname\gobble
1530 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1531 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1532 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1533 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
1535 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1536 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1537 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1538 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1539 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1540 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1543 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1551 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-
0 def
1553 1 begincodespacerange
1609 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1615 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname#1{%
1616 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1621 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1622 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1623 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1624 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1625 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1626 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1629 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1637 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-
0 def
1639 1 begincodespacerange
1697 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1703 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname#1{%
1704 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1709 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1710 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1711 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1712 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1713 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1714 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1717 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1725 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-
0 def
1727 1 begincodespacerange
1772 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1778 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname#1{%
1779 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1784 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
1785 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1786 % encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
1794 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1795 \font#1=
\fontprefix#2#3 scaled
#4
1796 \csname cmap
#5\endcsname#1%
1798 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1803 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1804 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1805 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1806 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
1809 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1811 \def\rmbshape{bx
} % where the normal face is bold
1816 \def\ttslshape{sltt
}
1826 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
1828 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1829 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1830 \def\textnominalsize{11pt
}
1831 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1832 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1833 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1834 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1835 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
1836 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1837 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1838 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1839 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1840 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1841 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1842 \def\textecsize{1095}
1844 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1845 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1846 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1847 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1848 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1849 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf
1850 \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \let\tensl=
\defsl \bf}
1852 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1853 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
1854 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1855 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1856 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1857 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1858 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1859 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1860 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1861 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
1864 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1866 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1867 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
1868 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1869 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1870 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1871 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1872 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1873 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1874 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1875 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
1876 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1877 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1878 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1880 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1881 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
1882 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1883 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
1884 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1885 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
1886 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
1887 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1888 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
1889 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1890 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
1891 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
1892 \def\titleecsize{2074}
1894 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
1895 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt
}
1896 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1897 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT
}
1898 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1899 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
1900 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
1901 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1
}
1903 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1904 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep2
1905 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep3
1906 \def\chapecsize{1728}
1908 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
1909 \def\secnominalsize{14pt
}
1910 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1911 \setfont\secrmnotbold\rmshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1912 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
1913 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1914 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1915 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
1916 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1918 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1919 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
1920 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
1921 \def\sececsize{1440}
1923 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
1924 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt
}
1925 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1926 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT
}
1927 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
1928 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1929 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT
}
1930 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1932 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
1933 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstephalf
1934 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled
1315
1935 \def\ssececsize{1200}
1937 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
1938 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt
}
1939 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1940 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1941 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1942 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1943 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1944 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1945 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1946 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1947 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
1948 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
1949 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
1951 \textleading =
13.2pt
% line spacing for 11pt CM
1952 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
1954 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
1957 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
1958 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
1959 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
1960 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
1962 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
1963 % Text fonts (10pt).
1964 \def\textnominalsize{10pt
}
1965 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
1966 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1967 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1968 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1969 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
1970 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1971 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1972 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1973 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1974 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1975 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1976 \def\textecsize{1000}
1978 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1979 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1980 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1981 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1982 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1983 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf
1984 \let\tensl=
\defsl \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \bf}
1986 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1987 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
1988 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1989 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1990 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1991 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1992 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1993 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1994 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1995 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
1998 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2000 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2001 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
2002 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2003 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2004 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
2005 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2006 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2007 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
2008 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
2009 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
2010 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2011 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2012 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2014 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2015 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
2016 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
2017 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
2018 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2019 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
2020 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
2021 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2022 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
2023 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
2024 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
2025 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
2026 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2028 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2029 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt
}
2030 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2031 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
2032 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2033 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2034 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
2035 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2037 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
2038 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
2039 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
2040 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2042 % Section fonts (12pt).
2043 \def\secnominalsize{12pt
}
2044 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2045 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT
}
2046 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2047 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2048 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2049 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2051 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2053 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep1
2054 \def\sececsize{1200}
2056 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2057 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt
}
2058 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2059 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2060 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2061 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2062 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2063 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2065 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2068 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2070 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2071 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt
}
2072 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2073 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2074 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2075 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2076 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2077 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2078 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2079 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
2080 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2081 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2082 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2084 \divide\parskip by
2 % reduce space between paragraphs
2085 \textleading =
12pt
% line spacing for 10pt CM
2086 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2088 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
2091 % We provide the user-level command
2093 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2099 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2100 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2101 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2103 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2104 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2106 \begingroup \globaldefs=
1
2107 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2108 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2111 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `
10' or `
11', not `
\textsizearg'
}
2116 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2117 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. We don't
2118 % bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
2120 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2121 \textfont0=
\tenrm \textfont1=
\teni \textfont2=
\tensy
2122 \textfont\itfam=
\tenit \textfont\slfam=
\tensl \textfont\bffam=
\tenbf
2123 \textfont\ttfam=
\tentt \textfont\sffam=
\tensf
2126 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2127 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2128 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2129 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2131 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2132 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used
2133 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2135 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2138 \let\tenrm=
\textrm \let\tenit=
\textit \let\tensl=
\textsl
2139 \let\tenbf=
\textbf \let\tentt=
\texttt \let\smallcaps=
\textsc
2140 \let\tensf=
\textsf \let\teni=
\texti \let\tensy=
\textsy
2141 \let\tenttsl=
\textttsl
2142 \def\curfontsize{text
}%
2143 \def\lsize{reduced
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2144 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2146 \let\tenrm=
\titlerm \let\tenit=
\titleit \let\tensl=
\titlesl
2147 \let\tenbf=
\titlebf \let\tentt=
\titlett \let\smallcaps=
\titlesc
2148 \let\tensf=
\titlesf \let\teni=
\titlei \let\tensy=
\titlesy
2149 \let\tenttsl=
\titlettsl
2150 \def\curfontsize{title
}%
2151 \def\lsize{chap
}\def\lllsize{subsec
}%
2152 \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt
}}
2153 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}}
2155 \let\tenrm=
\chaprm \let\tenit=
\chapit \let\tensl=
\chapsl
2156 \let\tenbf=
\chapbf \let\tentt=
\chaptt \let\smallcaps=
\chapsc
2157 \let\tensf=
\chapsf \let\teni=
\chapi \let\tensy=
\chapsy
2158 \let\tenttsl=
\chapttsl
2159 \def\curfontsize{chap
}%
2160 \def\lsize{sec
}\def\lllsize{text
}%
2161 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt
}}
2163 \let\tenrm=
\secrm \let\tenit=
\secit \let\tensl=
\secsl
2164 \let\tenbf=
\secbf \let\tentt=
\sectt \let\smallcaps=
\secsc
2165 \let\tensf=
\secsf \let\teni=
\seci \let\tensy=
\secsy
2166 \let\tenttsl=
\secttsl
2167 \def\curfontsize{sec
}%
2168 \def\lsize{subsec
}\def\lllsize{reduced
}%
2169 \resetmathfonts \setleading{17pt
}}
2171 \let\tenrm=
\ssecrm \let\tenit=
\ssecit \let\tensl=
\ssecsl
2172 \let\tenbf=
\ssecbf \let\tentt=
\ssectt \let\smallcaps=
\ssecsc
2173 \let\tensf=
\ssecsf \let\teni=
\sseci \let\tensy=
\ssecsy
2174 \let\tenttsl=
\ssecttsl
2175 \def\curfontsize{ssec
}%
2176 \def\lsize{text
}\def\lllsize{small
}%
2177 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt
}}
2178 \let\subsubsecfonts =
\subsecfonts
2180 \let\tenrm=
\reducedrm \let\tenit=
\reducedit \let\tensl=
\reducedsl
2181 \let\tenbf=
\reducedbf \let\tentt=
\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=
\reducedsc
2182 \let\tensf=
\reducedsf \let\teni=
\reducedi \let\tensy=
\reducedsy
2183 \let\tenttsl=
\reducedttsl
2184 \def\curfontsize{reduced
}%
2185 \def\lsize{small
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2186 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2188 \let\tenrm=
\smallrm \let\tenit=
\smallit \let\tensl=
\smallsl
2189 \let\tenbf=
\smallbf \let\tentt=
\smalltt \let\smallcaps=
\smallsc
2190 \let\tensf=
\smallsf \let\teni=
\smalli \let\tensy=
\smallsy
2191 \let\tenttsl=
\smallttsl
2192 \def\curfontsize{small
}%
2193 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2194 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2196 \let\tenrm=
\smallerrm \let\tenit=
\smallerit \let\tensl=
\smallersl
2197 \let\tenbf=
\smallerbf \let\tentt=
\smallertt \let\smallcaps=
\smallersc
2198 \let\tensf=
\smallersf \let\teni=
\smalleri \let\tensy=
\smallersy
2199 \let\tenttsl=
\smallerttsl
2200 \def\curfontsize{smaller
}%
2201 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2202 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt
}}
2204 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2205 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2206 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
} % no cmb12
2207 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2208 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2210 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2211 \def\angleleft{$
\langle$
}
2212 \def\angleright{$
\rangle$
}
2214 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2215 \let\smallexamplefonts =
\smallfonts
2217 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2218 % can fit this many characters:
2219 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2220 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2221 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2222 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2223 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2225 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2226 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2229 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2231 \definetextfontsizexi
2236 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2237 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2238 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2239 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2241 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=
0pt
}
2243 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2244 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2245 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2246 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
2247 % currently in effect.
2251 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
2252 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
2255 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
2256 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
2257 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
2258 \newif\ifmarkupexample
2260 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim
2262 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2264 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2265 \csname markup
#1true
\endcsname
2266 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2270 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2272 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2273 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2274 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2278 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2279 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2280 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2281 \csname markupsetuplq
\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2282 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2285 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2286 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2287 \csname markupsetuprq
\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2288 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2295 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`
\lq}
2296 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'
\rq}
2298 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`
\codequoteleft}
2299 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'
\codequoteright}
2302 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2303 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2305 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2306 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2308 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
2309 \let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
2311 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
2312 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
2314 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2315 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2317 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2318 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2320 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
2321 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
2322 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
2323 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
2324 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
2326 \def\codequoteright{%
2327 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
2328 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
2334 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2335 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2336 % the code environments to do likewise.
2338 \def\codequoteleft{%
2339 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
2340 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
2341 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2342 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2348 % Commands to set the quote options.
2350 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
2353 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname
2355 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2356 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname
2359 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2360 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `
\temp', must be on|off
}%
2364 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
2367 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname
2369 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2370 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname
2373 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2374 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `
\temp', must be on|off
}%
2378 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2379 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2381 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2382 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=
0
2386 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
2387 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
2388 % and 2) do not add an italic correction.
2389 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
2391 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=
\relax}%
2392 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
2395 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
2396 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
2398 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
2399 % character) is such as not to need one.
2400 \def\smartitaliccorrection{%
2405 \else\ifx\next\comma%
2411 % Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
2412 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
2414 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2415 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2416 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
2420 \let\saveaftersmartic =
\aftersmartic
2421 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=
\saveaftersmartic}%
2426 \let\slanted=
\smartslanted
2427 \let\dfn=
\smartslanted
2428 \let\emph=
\smartitalic
2430 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2431 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2432 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2433 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2435 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2439 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2440 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2442 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2443 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2444 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2446 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -
1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2447 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `-
}
2449 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2450 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2451 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2454 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2455 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m
\sfcode\questChar=\@m
\sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2456 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m
\sfcode\semiChar =\@m
\sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2457 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2459 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2460 \sfcode`\
.3000\sfcode`\?
3000\sfcode`\!
3000
2461 \sfcode`\:
2000\sfcode`\;
1500\sfcode`\,
1250
2462 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2465 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2467 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2469 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2474 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp
}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2476 % @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
2477 \let\indicateurl=
\samp
2479 % @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
2480 % size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
2481 % This is a subroutine for that.
2484 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2485 \spaceskip =
\fontdimen2\font
2487 % Switch to typewriter.
2490 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2491 \def\
{{\spaceskip =
0pt
{} }}%
2493 % Turn off hyphenation.
2500 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
2503 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2504 % (But see \codedashfinish below.)
2505 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2506 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2508 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2509 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2510 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2511 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
2513 \catcode`\-=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active
2514 \catcode`\'=
\active \catcode`\`=
\active
2515 \global\let'=
\rq \global\let`=
\lq % default definitions
2517 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2518 \setupmarkupstyle{code
}%
2519 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2520 \catcode\dashChar=
\active \catcode\underChar=
\active
2528 % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
2530 \global\let\codedashprev=
\codedash
2535 \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
2536 \gdef\codedashfinish{%
2537 \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
2539 % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
2540 % (a) the next character is a -, or
2541 % (b) the preceding character is a -.
2542 % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
2543 % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
2544 \ifx\next\codedash \else
2545 \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
2546 \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
2548 % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
2549 % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
2550 \global\let\codedashprev=
\next
2555 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2558 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2559 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2560 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2561 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2563 \mathchar"
075F
% class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2564 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2565 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2569 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2570 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
2571 % @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
2574 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2576 \def\keywordtrue{true
}
2577 \def\keywordfalse{false
}
2579 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2581 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2582 \allowcodebreakstrue
2583 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2584 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2586 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2587 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `
\txiarg', must be true|false
}%
2591 % For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
2592 % so use \code rather than \samp.
2598 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
2599 % (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
2600 % an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
2601 % addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
2603 % TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
2604 % arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
2605 \newif\ifurefurlonlylink
2607 % The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
2608 % places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
2609 % didn't support automatic breaking.)
2610 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
2611 \let\uref=
\urefbreak
2613 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,
\finish}
2614 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
2617 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2619 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2621 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
2625 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
2628 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
2629 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
2630 \unhbox0\ (
\urefcode{#1})
%
2633 \unhbox0\ (
\urefcode{#1})
% DVI, always show arg and url
2636 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
2642 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
2644 \catcode\ampChar=
\active \catcode\dotChar=
\active
2645 \catcode\hashChar=
\active \catcode\questChar=
\active
2646 \catcode\slashChar=
\active
2651 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
2652 \setupmarkupstyle{code
}%
2662 % By default, they are just regular characters.
2663 \global\def&
{\normalamp}
2664 \global\def.
{\normaldot}
2665 \global\def#
{\normalhash}
2666 \global\def?
{\normalquest}
2667 \global\def/
{\normalslash}
2670 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
2671 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
2672 % cmtt at least, especially for dots.
2673 \def\urefprestretchamount{.13em
}
2674 \def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em
}
2675 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus
\urefprestretchamount\relax}
2676 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus
\urefprestretchamount\relax}
2678 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&
\urefpoststretch}
2679 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .
\urefpoststretch}
2680 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#
\urefpoststretch}
2681 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?
\urefpoststretch}
2682 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
2685 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
2686 \urefprestretch \slashChar
2687 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
2688 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
2689 \ifx\next/
\else \urefpoststretch \fi
2693 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
2694 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
2695 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
2697 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
2699 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
2700 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2701 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
2702 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2703 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
2704 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
2706 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2707 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `
\txiarg'
}%
2710 \def\wordafter{after
}
2711 \def\wordbefore{before
}
2714 \urefbreakstyle after
2716 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2720 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2721 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2723 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2725 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,
\finish}
2726 \def\doemail#1,
#2,
#3\finish{\begingroup
2729 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2730 \ifdim\wd0>
0pt
\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2737 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2738 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2739 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2740 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2742 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2743 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2744 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2745 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2746 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2747 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2749 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2750 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `
\txiarg'
}%
2753 \def\worddistinct{distinct
}
2754 \def\wordexample{example
}
2757 % Default is `distinct'.
2758 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2760 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2761 % then @kbd has no effect.
2762 \def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??
\par}}
2765 \def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
2766 \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??
}%
2767 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2768 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd
}\look}}\fi
2769 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd
}\look}}\fi
2772 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
2773 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2775 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2776 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
2777 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
2778 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2779 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
2780 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2782 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
2783 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
2784 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
2786 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key
}%
2788 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
2791 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
2792 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
2794 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
2795 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
2798 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2799 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2801 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2803 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2804 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2807 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,
\finish}
2808 \def\doacronym#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2809 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2811 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2812 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2814 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2817 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2818 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2820 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,
\finish}
2821 \def\doabbr#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2822 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2824 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2825 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2827 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2830 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
2834 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
2836 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
2837 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
2838 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
2839 % which is what @var uses.
2841 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
2842 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
2844 \def_{\ifnum\fam=
\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
2847 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
2848 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
2849 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
2851 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
2852 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=
\ttfam \mathchar"
075C
\else\backslash \fi}
2857 \let\\ =
\mathbackslash
2859 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
2869 % have to provide another name for sup operator
2873 \def\finishmath#1{#1$
\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
2875 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
2876 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
2877 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
2880 \catcode`^ =
\active
2881 \catcode`< =
\active
2882 \catcode`> =
\active
2883 \catcode`+ =
\active
2884 \catcode`' =
\active
2890 \let' =
\ptexquoteright
2894 % for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
2895 % If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
2896 % into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the
2897 % one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
2898 % fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
2900 \def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
2901 \def\finishsub#1{$
\sb{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$
}%
2903 \def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
2904 \def\finishsup#1{$
\ptexsp{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$
}%
2906 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
2907 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
2908 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
2910 \def\outfmtnametex{tex
}
2912 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,
\finish}
2913 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,
#2,
\finish{%
2914 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
2915 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2918 % @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
2919 % FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
2920 \long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,
\finish}
2921 \long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
\finish{%
2922 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
2923 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
2926 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
2927 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
2928 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
2929 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
2930 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
2931 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
2932 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
2934 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
2935 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,
\finish}
2936 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,
#2,
\finish{%
2937 \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
2938 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2939 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
2942 % @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
2944 \long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,
\finish}
2945 \long\def\doinlineifset#1,
#2,
\finish{%
2946 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
2947 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
2948 \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
2951 % @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
2953 \long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,
\finish}
2954 \long\def\doinlineifclear#1,
#2,
\finish{%
2955 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
2956 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
2963 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
2967 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
2968 % Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do
2969 % not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math.
2970 \def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}}
2971 \def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}}
2972 \let\
{=
\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\
{
2973 \let\
}=
\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\
}
2975 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
2976 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
2977 \catcode`\
{ =
\other \catcode`\
} =
\other
2978 \catcode`\
[ =
1 \catcode`\
] =
2
2979 \catcode`\! =
0 \catcode`\\ =
\other
2980 !gdef!lbracecmd
[\
{]%
2981 !gdef!rbracecmd
[\
}]%
2982 !gdef!lbraceatcmd
[@
{]%
2983 !gdef!rbraceatcmd
[@
}]%
2986 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
2989 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
2990 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
2992 \let\dotaccent =
\ptexdot
2993 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
2994 \let\tieaccent =
\ptext
2995 \let\ubaraccent =
\ptexb
2996 \let\udotaccent =
\d
2998 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
2999 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
3000 \def\questiondown{?`
}
3002 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a
}}}
3003 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o
}}}
3005 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
3010 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
3011 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
3012 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j
}%
3016 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
3017 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
3019 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=
1000 }
3021 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
3022 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
3023 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
3024 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
3025 % \scriptscriptstyle).
3030 \vbox to
\ht0{\hbox{%
3031 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
3032 % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
3033 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
3034 \count255=
\the\fam $
\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$
%
3036 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
3037 \selectfonts\lllsize A
%
3046 % Some math mode symbols. Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
3047 % unless we are already there. Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
3048 % but safer, and can't hurt.
3049 \def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
3050 \def\ensuredmath#1{$
\relax#1$
}
3052 \def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
3053 \def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
3054 \def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
3055 \def\minus{\ensuremath-
}
3057 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
3058 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
3059 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
3060 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
3061 % whichever is larger.
3065 \setbox0=
\hbox{...
}% get width of three periods
3072 \hskip 0pt plus
.25fil
3073 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3074 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3075 .
\hskip 0pt plus
.5fil
3079 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
3083 \spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor
3086 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
3088 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
3089 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
3092 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\rightarrow$
\hfil}}
3093 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\Rightarrow$
\hfil}}
3094 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\mapsto$
\hfil}}
3095 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\dashv$
\hfil}}
3096 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\ptexequiv$
\hfil}}
3098 % The @error{} command.
3099 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
3103 {\tentt \global\dimen0 =
3em
}% Width of the box.
3104 \dimen2 =
.55pt
% Thickness of rules
3105 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
3106 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\kern-
.75pt
\reducedsf \putworderror\kern-
1.5pt
}
3108 \setbox\errorbox=
\hbox to
\dimen0{\hfil
3109 \hsize =
\dimen0 \advance\hsize by -
5.8pt
% Space to left+right.
3110 \advance\hsize by -
2\dimen2 % Rules.
3112 \hrule height
\dimen2
3113 \hbox{\vrule width
\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
3114 \vtop{\kern2.4pt
\box0 \kern2.4pt
}% Space above/below.
3115 \kern3pt\vrule width
\dimen2}% Space to right.
3116 \hrule height
\dimen2}
3119 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex
\copy\errorbox}
3121 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
3123 \def\pounds{{\it\$
}}
3125 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
3126 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
3127 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
3128 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
3129 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
3131 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
3132 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
3138 % feybo - bold slanted
3140 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
3141 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
3144 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
3148 \def\euro{{\eurofont e
}}
3150 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
3151 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
3152 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
3155 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
3156 % that to the current nominal size.
3158 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
3159 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
3161 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize
\endcsname}%
3163 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3165 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feybo10
}{feybr10
} at
\eurosize
3168 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feymo10
}{feymr10
} at
\eurosize
3173 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
3174 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
3177 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
3178 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0
}} % Eth
3179 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0
}} % eth
3180 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE
}} % Thorn
3181 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE
}} % thorn
3183 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"
13}}
3184 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
3185 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"
14}}
3186 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
3187 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"
0E
}}
3188 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"
0F
}}
3189 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"
12}}
3190 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"
0D
}}
3192 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
3193 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
3194 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
3195 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
3197 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
3198 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
3202 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
3203 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
3204 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
3205 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
3207 \ecfont \setbox0=
\hbox{#1}%
3208 \ifdim\ht0=
1ex
\accent"
0C
#1%
3209 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"
0C
\hidewidth}%
3214 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"
81}}\def\macrocharA{A
}
3215 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1
}}\def\macrochara{a
}
3216 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"
86}}\def\macrocharE{E
}
3217 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6
}}\def\macrochare{e
}
3219 % Use the European Computer Modern fonts (cm-super in outline format)
3220 % for non-CM glyphs. That is ec* for regular text and tc* for the text
3221 % companion symbols (LaTeX TS1 encoding). Both are part of the ec
3222 % package and follow the same conventions.
3224 \def\ecfont{\etcfont{e
}}
3225 \def\tcfont{\etcfont{t
}}
3228 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
3229 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
3230 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
3231 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
3232 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize
\endcsname}%
3233 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize
\endcsname}%
3236 \font\thisecfont =
#1ctt
\ecsize \space at
\nominalsize
3238 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3240 \font\thisecfont =
#1cb
\ifusingit{i
}{x
}\ecsize \space at
\nominalsize
3243 \font\thisecfont =
#1c
\ifusingit{ti
}{rm
}\ecsize \space at
\nominalsize
3249 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
3250 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
3251 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
3253 \def\registeredsymbol{%
3254 $^
{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex
\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R
}%
3259 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
3261 \def\textdegree{$^
\circ$
}
3263 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
3264 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
3265 % so we'll define it if necessary.
3267 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
3268 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
3272 \chardef\quotedblleft="
5C
3273 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
3274 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
3275 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
3278 \message{page headings,
}
3280 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue =
1.5in
3281 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue =
2pc
3283 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
3285 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
3287 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
3288 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
3290 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3291 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3292 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3293 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3295 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
3296 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in
\chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3297 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3300 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3302 \parindent=
0pt
\textfonts
3303 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3304 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3305 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3306 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3308 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3309 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3310 \let\oldpage =
\page
3312 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3315 \let\page =
\oldpage
3322 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3325 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3326 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3327 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3328 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3332 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3333 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3336 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
3337 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3340 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
3341 \global\let\contents =
\relax
3344 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3346 \global\let\contents =
\relax
3347 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
3351 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3352 \vskip4pt \hrule height
2pt width
\hsize
3353 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3354 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3357 % Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
3358 % don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
3359 % inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. Because
3360 % it is always used for titles, nothing else, we call \rmisbold. \par
3361 % should be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
3363 \def\raggedtitlesettings{%
3365 \hyphenpenalty=
10000
3371 % Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3373 \let\subtitlerm=
\tenrm
3374 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip =
13pt
\normalbaselines}
3376 \parseargdef\title{%
3378 \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
3379 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3380 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3381 \vskip4pt \hrule height
4pt width
\hsize \vskip4pt
3384 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3386 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3389 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3390 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3392 \parseargdef\author{%
3393 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3395 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3398 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus
1filll
\seenauthortrue \fi
3399 {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}%
3404 % Set up page headings and footings.
3406 \let\thispage=
\folio
3408 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3409 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3410 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3411 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3413 % Now make \makeheadline and \makefootline in Plain TeX use those variables
3414 \headline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3415 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3416 \footline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3417 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3418 \let\HEADINGShook=
\relax
3420 % Commands to set those variables.
3421 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3422 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3423 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3424 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3425 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3428 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3429 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3430 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3431 \global\evenheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3433 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3434 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3435 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3436 \global\oddheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3438 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3440 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3441 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3442 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3443 \global\evenfootline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3445 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3446 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3447 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3448 \global\oddfootline =
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3450 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3451 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3452 \global\advance\pageheight by -
12pt
3453 \global\advance\vsize by -
12pt
3456 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3458 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3459 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3461 % The same set of arguments for:
3466 % @everyheadingmarks
3467 % @everyfootingmarks
3469 % These define \getoddheadingmarks, \getevenheadingmarks,
3470 % \getoddfootingmarks, and \getevenfootingmarks, each to one of
3471 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks.
3473 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even
}{heading
}}
3474 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd
}{heading
}}
3475 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even
}{footing
}}
3476 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd
}{footing
}}
3477 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even
}{heading
}{#1}
3478 \headingmarks{odd
}{heading
}{#1} }
3479 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even
}{footing
}{#1}
3480 \headingmarks{odd
}{footing
}{#1} }
3481 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3482 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3483 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get
#3headingmarks
\endcsname
3484 \global\expandafter\let\csname get
#1#2marks
\endcsname \temp
3487 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3488 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3490 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3491 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3492 % @headings off turns them off.
3493 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3494 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3495 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3496 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3497 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3498 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3500 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS
#1\endcsname}
3502 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
3503 \evenheadline=
{\hfil}\evenfootline=
{\hfil}%
3504 \oddheadline=
{\hfil}\oddfootline=
{\hfil}%
3507 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=
1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
3508 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default
3510 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3511 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3512 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3513 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3514 % edge of all pages.
3515 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3517 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3518 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3519 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3520 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3521 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
3523 \let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3525 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3526 % page number on top right.
3527 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3529 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3530 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3531 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3532 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3533 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3535 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3537 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSdoublex}
3538 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=
\HEADINGSafter
3539 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3540 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3541 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3542 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3543 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3544 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
3547 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSsinglex}
3548 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3549 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3550 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3551 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3552 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3553 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3556 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3557 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3558 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3559 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3560 \ifx\today\thisisundefined
3564 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3565 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3566 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3571 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3572 % It generates no output of its own.
3573 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3574 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3578 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3580 % default indentation of table text
3581 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=
.8in
3582 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3583 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=
.3in
3584 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3585 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=
.1in
3587 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3590 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3592 % They also define \itemindex
3593 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3595 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3597 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-
\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3599 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3600 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3602 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3603 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
3604 \advance\hsize by -
\tableindent
3605 \setbox0=
\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3607 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3609 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3610 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3611 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3612 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3613 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3614 \ifdim \wd0>
\itemmax
3616 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3617 % but leave it ragged-right.
3619 \advance\leftskip by-
\tableindent
3620 \advance\hsize by
\tableindent
3621 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
\relax
3622 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3625 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3626 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3627 \nobreak \vskip-
\parskip
3629 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3630 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3631 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3632 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3633 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3634 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3638 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3640 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3641 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3643 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3644 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3645 % eventually be printed.
3646 \nobreak\kern-
\tableindent
3647 \dimen0 =
\itemmax \advance\dimen0 by
\itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0
3649 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
3651 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
3655 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment
}}
3656 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment
}}
3658 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
3660 \let\itemindex\gobble
3664 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {fn
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
3665 \tablecheck{ftable
}%
3668 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {vr
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
3669 \tablecheck{vtable
}%
3672 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=
\active
3674 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
3675 that we are
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
3676 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
3683 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
3688 \makevalueexpandable
3689 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
3693 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3695 \ifnum 0#1>
0 \advance \leftskip by
#1\mil \fi
3696 \ifnum 0#2>
0 \tableindent=
#2\mil \fi
3697 \ifnum 0#3>
0 \advance \rightskip by
#3\mil \fi
3698 \itemmax=
\tableindent
3699 \advance \itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3700 \advance \leftskip by
\tableindent
3701 \exdentamount=
\tableindent
3703 \parskip =
\smallskipamount
3704 \ifdim \parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3705 \let\item =
\internalBitem
3706 \let\itemx =
\internalBitemx
3708 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3711 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3712 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3714 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3718 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3722 \itemmax=
\itemindent
3723 \advance\itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3724 \advance\leftskip by
\itemindent
3725 \exdentamount=
\itemindent
3727 \parskip=
\smallskipamount
3728 \ifdim\parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3730 % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
3731 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
3732 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
3733 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
3734 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
3735 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3736 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\itemcontents}%
3738 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3739 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3741 \let\item=
\itemizeitem
3744 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3747 \advance\itemno by
1 % for enumerations
3748 {\let\par=
\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3750 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3751 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3752 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3753 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3754 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3755 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3756 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3757 % that's the theory.
3758 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \parskip=
0in
\fi
3760 \hbox to
0pt
{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3763 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}% not good to break after first line of item.
3765 % We can be in inner vertical mode in a footnote, although an
3766 % @itemize looks awful there.
3771 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3772 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3774 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3776 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3777 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3778 % argument is the same as `1'.
3780 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3781 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3782 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3784 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3786 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3787 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3788 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3789 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3790 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3791 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3793 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3794 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3795 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3796 % not equal to itself.
3797 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3799 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3800 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3802 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
0\relax
3803 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3806 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
\expandafter`
\thearg\relax
3807 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3809 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3813 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3818 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3821 \def\numericenumerate{%
3823 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3826 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3827 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3828 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3830 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3832 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3839 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3840 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3841 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3843 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3845 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3852 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3853 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3854 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3856 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3857 \advance\itemno by -
1
3858 \doitemize{#1.
}\flushcr
3861 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3864 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a
}}
3865 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A
}}
3866 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3867 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3870 % @multitable macros
3871 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3873 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3874 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3875 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3876 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3878 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3882 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3883 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3886 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3887 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3888 % columns as desired.
3891 % Or use a template:
3892 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3894 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3896 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3897 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3898 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3899 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3901 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3904 % Sample multitable:
3906 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3907 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3914 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3915 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3917 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3918 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3921 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3922 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3923 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3924 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3925 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3927 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3929 \newskip\multitableparskip
3930 \newskip\multitableparindent
3931 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3932 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3933 \multitableparskip=
0pt
3934 \multitableparindent=
6pt
3935 \multitablecolspace=
12pt
3936 \multitablelinespace=
0pt
3938 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3940 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3941 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3942 \let\columnfractions\relax
3943 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3946 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3947 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3949 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3950 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3951 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3958 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3961 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3962 \global\setpercenttrue
3965 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3967 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3968 \setbox0=
\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3969 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3970 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3973 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3974 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3975 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3976 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3978 \let\go =
\setuptable
3984 % multitable-only commands.
3986 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments
3987 % have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
3988 % alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
3989 % undo it ourselves.
3990 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
3992 \checkenv\multitable
3994 \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
3995 \global\everytab=
{\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
3996 \the\everytab % for the first item
3999 % default for tables with no headings.
4000 \let\headitemcrhook=
\relax
4002 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
4003 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
4004 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
4005 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
4006 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &
\the\everytab}%
4008 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
4010 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
4012 \envdef\multitable{%
4016 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
4017 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
4018 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
4019 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
4024 \setmultitablespacing
4025 \parskip=
\multitableparskip
4026 \parindent=
\multitableparindent
4032 \global\everytab=
{}% Reset from possible headitem.
4033 \global\colcount=
0 % Reset the column counter.
4035 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
4038 % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
4040 \global\let\headitemcrhook=
\relax
4044 \parsearg\domultitable
4046 \def\domultitable#1{%
4047 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
4048 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
4050 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
4051 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
4052 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
4053 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
4055 \global\advance\colcount by
1
4058 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
4059 \hsize=
\expandafter\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname
4061 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
4062 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
4065 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
4066 % to the width of each template entry.
4068 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
4069 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
4070 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
4071 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
4073 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
4076 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
4077 \advance\hsize by
\leftskip
4080 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
4081 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
4082 \advance\hsize by
\multitablecolspace
4084 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
4085 \leftskip=
\multitablecolspace
4087 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
4088 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
4089 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
4091 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
4093 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
4094 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
4095 % marking characters.
4096 \noindent\ignorespaces##
\unskip\multistrut
4101 \egroup % end the \halign
4102 \global\setpercentfalse
4105 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
4106 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
4108 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
4109 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
4110 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
4111 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
4112 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=
0pt
4113 \setbox0=
\vbox{X
}\global\multitablelinespace=
\the\baselineskip
4114 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-
\ht0
4116 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
4117 % table. If not, do nothing.
4118 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
4119 \ifdim\multitableparskip>
\multitablelinespace
4120 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
4121 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4122 % than skip between lines in the table.
4124 \ifdim\multitableparskip=
0pt
4125 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
4126 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4127 % than skip between lines in the table.
4131 \message{conditionals,
}
4133 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
4134 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
4135 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
4136 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
4137 % attempt to close an environment group.
4140 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname =
\relax
4141 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname =
1
4144 \makecond{ifnotdocbook
}
4145 \makecond{ifnothtml
}
4146 \makecond{ifnotinfo
}
4147 \makecond{ifnotplaintext
}
4150 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
4152 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry
}}
4153 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription
}}
4154 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook
}}
4155 \def\html{\doignore{html
}}
4156 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook
}}
4157 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml
}}
4158 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo
}}
4159 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex
}}
4160 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext
}}
4161 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml
}}
4162 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore
}}
4163 \def\menu{\doignore{menu
}}
4164 \def\xml{\doignore{xml
}}
4166 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
4168 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
4169 \newcount\doignorecount
4171 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
4172 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
4174 \catcode`\@ =
\other
4175 \catcode`\
{ =
\other
4176 \catcode`\
} =
\other
4178 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
4181 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
4184 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
4188 { \catcode`_=
11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
4191 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
4192 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
4194 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
4195 \long\def\doignoretext#
#1^^M@end
#1{%
4196 \doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1\_STOP_}%
4198 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
4199 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
4200 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
4201 \long\def\doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1#
#2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{#
#2}\_STOP_}%
4203 % And now expand that command.
4208 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
4210 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
4211 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
4212 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
4213 \advance\doignorecount by
1
4214 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
4215 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
4217 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
4220 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
4222 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
4223 \ifnum\doignorecount =
0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
4224 \let\next\enddoignore
4225 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
4226 \advance\doignorecount by -
1
4227 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
4232 % Finish off ignored text.
4234 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
4235 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
4236 % would result in a blank line in the output.
4237 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M
{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
4241 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
4242 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
4244 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
4245 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
4246 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
4248 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
4250 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
4251 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
4253 \makevalueexpandable
4255 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET
#1}}%
4263 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
4264 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
4266 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
4268 \parseargdef\clear{%
4270 \makevalueexpandable
4271 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET
#1\endcsname=
\relax
4275 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
4276 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
4277 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
4279 \catcode`\-=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active
4281 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
4282 \let\value =
\expandablevalue
4283 % We don't want these characters active, ...
4284 \catcode`\-=
\other \catcode`
\_=
\other
4285 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
4286 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
4287 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
4288 \let-
\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
4292 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
4293 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
4294 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
4295 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
4296 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
4297 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
4298 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
4300 % Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value*
4301 % of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr
4302 % dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's
4303 % been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it.
4305 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
4306 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#1\endcsname\relax
4307 {[No value for ``
#1''
]}%
4308 \message{Variable `
#1', used in @value, is not set.
}%
4310 \csname SET
#1\endcsname
4314 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
4317 % To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
4318 % \makecond and then redefine.
4321 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=
\ifsetfail}}}
4324 \makevalueexpandable
4326 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#2\endcsname\relax
4327 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
4332 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset
}}
4334 % @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
4335 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
4337 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
4338 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
4339 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
4342 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=
\ifclearfail}}}
4343 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear
}}
4345 % @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
4346 % without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
4347 % TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
4348 % defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
4350 \makecond{ifcommanddefined
}
4351 \def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=
\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
4353 \def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
4354 \makevalueexpandable
4356 \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
4357 #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
4362 \def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined
}}
4364 % @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
4365 \makecond{ifcommandnotdefined
}
4366 \def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
4367 \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=
\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
4368 \def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined
}}
4370 % Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
4371 % test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
4372 \set txicommandconditionals
4374 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4375 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4376 \let\dircategory=
\comment
4378 % @defininfoenclose.
4379 \let\definfoenclose=
\comment
4383 % Index generation facilities
4385 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4386 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4387 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite
}}
4389 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named IX.
4390 % It automatically defines \IXindex such that
4391 % \IXindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index IX.
4392 % It also defines \IXindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4393 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is IX.
4394 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4395 % for the sake of vms.
4398 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile
\endcsname=
0
4399 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4400 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4403 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4405 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4407 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4409 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4411 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4412 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile
\endcsname=
0
4413 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{%
4414 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4417 % The default indices:
4418 \newindex{cp
}% concepts,
4419 \newcodeindex{fn
}% functions,
4420 \newcodeindex{vr
}% variables,
4421 \newcodeindex{tp
}% types,
4422 \newcodeindex{ky
}% keys
4423 \newcodeindex{pg
}% and programs.
4426 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4427 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4429 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4432 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4433 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4435 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4436 % #3 the target index (bar).
4437 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4438 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
4439 % closing the target index.
4440 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex
#2\endcsname \relax
4441 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
4442 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
4443 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile
\endcsname
4444 \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex
#2\endcsname =
1
4446 % redefine \fooindfile:
4447 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=
\csname#3indfile
\endcsname
4448 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile
\endcsname=
\temp
4449 % redefine \fooindex:
4450 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index
\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4453 % Define \doindex, the driver for all index macros.
4454 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4455 % and it the two-letter name of the index.
4457 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\doindexxxx}
4458 \def\doindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4460 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4461 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\docodeindexxxx}
4462 \def\docodeindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4464 % Used when writing an index entry out to an index file, to prevent
4465 % expansion of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4468 \escapechar = `\\
% use backslash in output files.
4469 \def\@
{@
}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
4470 \def\
{\realbackslash\space }%
4472 % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy)
4473 % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text. Also, more
4474 % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
4475 % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
4476 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. Perhaps we
4477 % should use @lbracechar and @rbracechar?
4478 \def\
{{{\tt\char123}}%
4479 \def\
}{{\tt\char125}}%
4481 % Do the redefinitions.
4485 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
4486 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
4487 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
4488 % this will be simpler.
4493 \let\
{ =
\lbraceatcmd
4494 \let\
} =
\rbraceatcmd
4496 % Do the redefinitions.
4501 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
4503 \def\commondummies{%
4504 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4505 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
4506 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4507 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4508 % from whatever follows.
4510 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4513 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4514 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4515 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4517 \def\definedummyword #
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1\space}}%
4518 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1}}%
4519 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4521 \commondummiesnofonts
4523 \definedummyletter\_%
4524 \definedummyletter\-
%
4526 % Non-English letters.
4537 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4541 \definedummyword\ordf
4542 \definedummyword\ordm
4543 \definedummyword\questiondown
4547 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4549 \definedummyword\gtr
4550 \definedummyword\hat
4551 \definedummyword\less
4554 \definedummyword\tclose
4557 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4558 \definedummyword\TeX
4560 % Assorted special characters.
4561 \definedummyword\arrow
4562 \definedummyword\bullet
4563 \definedummyword\comma
4564 \definedummyword\copyright
4565 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4566 \definedummyword\dots
4567 \definedummyword\enddots
4568 \definedummyword\entrybreak
4569 \definedummyword\equiv
4570 \definedummyword\error
4571 \definedummyword\euro
4572 \definedummyword\expansion
4573 \definedummyword\geq
4574 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4575 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4576 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4577 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4578 \definedummyword\lbracechar
4579 \definedummyword\leq
4580 \definedummyword\mathopsup
4581 \definedummyword\minus
4582 \definedummyword\ogonek
4583 \definedummyword\pounds
4584 \definedummyword\point
4585 \definedummyword\print
4586 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4587 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4588 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4589 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4590 \definedummyword\quoteright
4591 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4592 \definedummyword\rbracechar
4593 \definedummyword\result
4594 \definedummyword\sub
4595 \definedummyword\sup
4596 \definedummyword\textdegree
4598 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4601 \normalturnoffactive
4603 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
4604 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
4605 \makevalueexpandable
4608 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
4609 % Define \definedumyletter, \definedummyaccent and \definedummyword before
4612 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4613 % Control letters and accents.
4614 \definedummyletter\!
%
4615 \definedummyaccent\"
%
4616 \definedummyaccent\'
%
4617 \definedummyletter\*
%
4618 \definedummyaccent\,
%
4619 \definedummyletter\.
%
4620 \definedummyletter\/
%
4621 \definedummyletter\:
%
4622 \definedummyaccent\=
%
4623 \definedummyletter\?
%
4624 \definedummyaccent\^
%
4625 \definedummyaccent\`
%
4626 \definedummyaccent\~
%
4630 \definedummyword\dotaccent
4631 \definedummyword\ogonek
4632 \definedummyword\ringaccent
4633 \definedummyword\tieaccent
4634 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
4635 \definedummyword\udotaccent
4636 \definedummyword\dotless
4638 % Texinfo font commands.
4642 \definedummyword\sansserif
4644 \definedummyword\slanted
4647 % Commands that take arguments.
4648 \definedummyword\abbr
4649 \definedummyword\acronym
4650 \definedummyword\anchor
4651 \definedummyword\cite
4652 \definedummyword\code
4653 \definedummyword\command
4654 \definedummyword\dfn
4655 \definedummyword\dmn
4656 \definedummyword\email
4657 \definedummyword\emph
4658 \definedummyword\env
4659 \definedummyword\file
4660 \definedummyword\image
4661 \definedummyword\indicateurl
4662 \definedummyword\inforef
4663 \definedummyword\kbd
4664 \definedummyword\key
4665 \definedummyword\math
4666 \definedummyword\option
4667 \definedummyword\pxref
4668 \definedummyword\ref
4669 \definedummyword\samp
4670 \definedummyword\strong
4671 \definedummyword\tie
4673 \definedummyword\uref
4674 \definedummyword\url
4675 \definedummyword\var
4676 \definedummyword\verb
4678 \definedummyword\xref
4681 % @macro mkind{arg1,arg2}
4685 % The space after the comma will end up in the temporary definition
4686 % that we make for arg2 (see \parsemargdef ff.). We want all this to be
4687 % expanded for the sake of the index, so we end up just seeing "bar".
4688 \let\xprocessmacroarg\eatspaces
4691 % For testing: output @{ and @} in index sort strings as \{ and \}.
4692 \newif\ifusebracesinindexes
4694 \let\indexlbrace\relax
4695 \let\indexrbrace\relax
4699 @gdef@backslashdisappear
{@def\
{}}
4706 \gdef\indexnonalnumdisappear{%
4707 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore
\endcsname\relax\else
4708 % @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us ignore left quotes in the sort term.
4709 % (Introduced for FSFS 2nd ed.)
4713 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexbackslashignore
\endcsname\relax\else
4717 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexhyphenignore
\endcsname\relax\else
4720 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlessthanignore
\endcsname\relax\else
4723 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexatsignignore
\endcsname\relax\else
4728 \gdef\indexnonalnumreappear{%
4737 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
4738 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
4739 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
4740 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
4743 % Accent commands should become @asis.
4744 \def\definedummyaccent#
#1{\let#
#1\asis}%
4745 % We can just ignore other control letters.
4746 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\let#
#1\empty}%
4747 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
4748 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
4749 \commondummiesnofonts
4751 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
4752 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
4753 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
4758 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
4759 \def\-
{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
4761 \def\lbracechar{{\indexlbrace}}%
4762 \def\rbracechar{{\indexrbrace}}%
4767 % Non-English letters.
4784 \def\questiondown{?
}%
4791 % Assorted special characters.
4792 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
4794 \def\bullet{bullet
}%
4796 \def\copyright{copyright
}%
4802 \def\expansion{==>
}%
4804 \def\guillemetleft{<<
}%
4805 \def\guillemetright{>>
}%
4806 \def\guilsinglleft{<
}%
4807 \def\guilsinglright{>
}%
4811 \def\pounds{pounds
}%
4813 \def\quotedblbase{"
}%
4814 \def\quotedblleft{"
}%
4815 \def\quotedblright{"
}%
4818 \def\quotesinglbase{,
}%
4819 \def\registeredsymbol{R
}%
4823 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
4824 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
4825 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
4826 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
4827 % that starts with \.
4829 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
4830 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
4831 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
4837 \let\SETmarginindex=
\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
4839 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
4840 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
4841 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4843 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
4844 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
4845 % TODO: Two-level index? Operation index?
4847 % Workhorse for all indexes.
4848 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4849 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4850 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4852 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4855 \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
4856 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4858 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4860 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4861 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4864 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile
\endcsname}%
4866 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4871 % Check if an index file has been opened, and if not, open it.
4872 \def\requireopenindexfile#1{%
4873 \ifnum\csname #1indfile
\endcsname=
0
4874 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile
\endcsname
4876 % A .fls suffix would conflict with the file extension for the output
4877 % of -recorder, so use .f1s instead.
4878 \ifx\suffix\indexisfl\def\suffix{f1
}\fi
4880 \immediate\openout\csname#1indfile
\endcsname \jobname.
\suffix
4881 % Using \immediate here prevents an object entering into the current box,
4882 % which could confound checks such as those in \safewhatsit for preceding
4887 % Output \ as {\indexbackslash}, because \ is an escape character in
4889 \let\indexbackslash=
\relax
4890 {\catcode`\@=
0 \catcode`\\=
\active
4891 @gdef@useindexbackslash
{@def\
{{@indexbackslash
}}}
4894 % Definition for writing index entry text.
4895 \def\sortas#1{\ignorespaces}%
4897 % Definition for writing index entry sort key. Should occur at the at
4898 % the beginning of the index entry, like
4899 % @cindex @sortas{september} \september
4900 % The \ignorespaces takes care of following space, but there's no way
4901 % to remove space before it.
4904 \gdef\indexwritesortas{%
4906 \indexnonalnumreappear
4907 \indexwritesortasxxx}
4908 \gdef\indexwritesortasxxx#1{%
4909 \xdef\indexsortkey{#1}\endgroup}
4913 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file.
4915 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4916 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4917 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4918 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt
\the\toks0}}%
4921 % Remember, we are within a group.
4922 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4923 \useindexbackslash % \indexbackslash isn't defined now so it will be output
4924 % as is; and it will print as backslash.
4925 % Get the string to sort by, by processing the index entry with all
4926 % font commands turned off.
4928 \indexnonalnumdisappear
4929 \xdef\indexsortkey{}%
4930 \let\sortas=
\indexwritesortas
4931 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}%
4932 \setbox\dummybox =
\hbox{\temp}% Make sure to execute any \sortas
4933 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty
4934 \xdef\indexsortkey{\temp}%
4935 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty\xdef\indexsortkey{ }\fi
4939 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4940 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4941 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4942 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4946 \string\entry{\indexsortkey}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4950 \newbox\dummybox % used above
4952 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4954 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4955 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4956 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4957 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4958 % sequences like this:
4962 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4963 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4964 % the previous defun.
4966 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4967 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4969 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4971 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4972 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4973 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4974 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4975 % representation of the skip.
4977 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4978 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4980 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip
\endcsname}
4982 \newskip\whatsitskip
4983 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4987 \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
4990 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4991 \whatsitskip =
\lastskip
4992 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4993 \whatsitpenalty =
\lastpenalty
4995 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4996 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4997 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4998 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4999 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
5000 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5007 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5008 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
5009 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
5010 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
5011 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
5012 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
5013 % @deffn deffn-whatever
5014 % @vindex index-whatever
5016 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
5017 % and the "Description." paragraph.
5018 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>
9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
5020 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
5021 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
5022 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
5023 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
5027 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
5028 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
5030 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
5031 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
5032 % containing these kinds of lines:
5034 % before the first topic whose initial is c
5035 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
5036 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
5038 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
5039 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
5040 % for each subtopic.
5042 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
5043 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
5045 \def\findex {\fnindex}
5046 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
5047 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
5048 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
5049 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
5050 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
5052 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
5054 \gdef\cindexsub "
#1"
#2^^M
{\endgroup %
5055 \dosubind{cp
}{#2}{#1}}}
5057 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
5059 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
5060 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
5062 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
5063 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
5068 \everypar =
{}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
5070 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
5071 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
5073 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
5074 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
5076 % See comment in \requireopenindexfile.
5077 \def\indexname{#1}\ifx\indexname\indexisfl\def\indexname{f1
}\fi
5078 \openin 1 \jobname.
\indexname s
5080 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
5081 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
5082 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
5083 % there is some text.
5084 \putwordIndexNonexistent
5089 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
5090 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
5091 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
5092 \read 1 to
\thisline
5094 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
5096 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
5097 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
5098 % to make right now.
5099 \def\indexbackslash{\ttbackslash}%
5100 \let\indexlbrace\
{ % Likewise, set these sequences for braces
5101 \let\indexrbrace\
} % used in the sort key.
5103 \let\entryorphanpenalty=
\indexorphanpenalty
5105 % Read input from the index file line by line.
5108 \let\firsttoken\relax
5110 \read 1 to
\nextline
5111 \edef\act{\gdef\noexpand\firsttoken{\getfirsttoken\nextline}}%
5117 \let\thisline\nextline
5126 \def\getfirsttoken#1{\expandafter\getfirsttokenx#1\endfirsttoken}
5127 \long\def\getfirsttokenx#1#2\endfirsttoken{\noexpand#1}
5129 \def\loopdo#1\repeat{\def\body{#1}\loopdoxxx}
5130 \def\loopdoxxx{\let\next=
\relax\body\let\next=
\loopdoxxx\fi\next}
5132 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
5133 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
5135 {\catcode`\/=
13 \catcode`\-=
13 \catcode`\^=
13 \catcode`\~=
13 \catcode`
\_=
13
5136 \catcode`\|=
13 \catcode`\<=
13 \catcode`\>=
13 \catcode`\+=
13 \catcode`\"=
13
5138 \gdef\initialglyphs{%
5139 % Some changes for non-alphabetic characters. Using the glyphs from the
5140 % math fonts looks more consistent than the typewriter font used elsewhere
5141 % for these characters.
5142 \def\indexbackslash{\math{\backslash}}%
5143 \let\\=
\indexbackslash
5145 % Can't get bold backslash so don't use bold forward slash
5147 \def/
{{\secrmnotbold \normalslash}}%
5148 \def-
{{\normaldash\normaldash}}% en dash `--'
5149 \def^
{{\chapbf \normalcaret}}%
5150 \def~
{{\chapbf \normaltilde}}%
5152 \leavevmode \kern.07em
\vbox{\hrule width
.3em height
.1ex
}\kern .07em
}%
5156 \def+
{$
\normalplus$
}%
5166 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
5169 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
5170 % The glue before the bonus allows a little bit of space at the
5171 % bottom of a column to reduce an increase in inter-line spacing.
5173 \vskip 0pt plus
5\baselineskip
5175 \vskip 0pt plus -
5\baselineskip
5177 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
5178 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
5179 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
5180 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
5182 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
5183 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus
1\baselineskip
5184 \leftline{\secfonts \kern-
0.05em
\secbf #1}%
5185 % \secfonts is inside the argument of \leftline so that the change of
5186 % \baselineskip will not affect any glue inserted before the vbox that
5187 % \leftline creates.
5188 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
5190 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
5191 \egroup % \initialglyphs
5194 \newdimen\entryrightmargin
5195 \entryrightmargin=
0pt
5197 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
5198 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
5199 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
5204 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
5205 % affect previous text.
5208 % No extra space above this paragraph.
5211 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
5212 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
5213 % titles, for instance.
5214 \def\*
{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5215 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}%
5217 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
5219 \vskip 0pt plus0.5pt
5221 % Badness calculation for paragraph affected by -
5222 % How much \indexdotfill is stretched, or how much \parfillskip is shrunk
5223 % Number of lines (\linepenalty)
5225 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
5226 \afterassignment\doentry
5229 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5231 % Save the text of the entry
5232 \global\setbox\boxA=
\hbox\bgroup
5233 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
5235 \aftergroup\finishentry
5236 % And now comes the text of the entry.
5237 % Not absorbing as a macro argument reduces the chance of problems
5238 % with catcodes occurring.
5241 \gdef\finishentry#1{%
5243 \dimen@ =
\wd\boxA % Length of text of entry
5244 \global\setbox\boxA=
\hbox\bgroup\unhbox\boxA
5245 % #1 is the page number.
5247 % Get the width of the page numbers, and only use
5248 % leaders if they are present.
5249 \global\setbox\boxB =
\hbox{#1}%
5250 \ifdim\wd\boxB =
0pt
5251 \null\nobreak\hfill\
%
5254 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
5258 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
5260 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable #1%
5264 \ifdim\wd\boxB =
0pt
5265 \global\setbox\entryindexbox=
\box\boxA
5267 \global\setbox\entryindexbox=
\vbox\bgroup\noindent
5268 % We want the text of the entries to be aligned to the left, and the
5269 % page numbers to be aligned to the right.
5271 \advance\leftskip by
0pt plus
1fil
5272 \advance\leftskip by
0pt plus -
1fill
5273 \rightskip =
0pt plus -
1fil
5274 \advance\rightskip by
0pt plus
1fill
5275 % Cause last line, which could consist of page numbers on their own
5276 % if the list of page numbers is long, to be aligned to the right.
5277 \parfillskip=
0pt plus -
1fill
5281 \advance\rightskip by
\entryrightmargin
5282 % Determine how far we can stretch into the margin.
5283 % This allows, e.g., "Appendix H GNU Free Documentation License" to
5284 % fit on one line in @letterpaper format.
5285 \ifdim\entryrightmargin>
2.1em
5290 \advance \parfillskip by
0pt minus
1\dimen@i
5293 \advance\dimen@ii by -
1\leftskip
5294 \advance\dimen@ii by -
1\entryrightmargin
5295 \advance\dimen@ii by
1\dimen@i
5296 \ifdim\wd\boxA >
\dimen@ii
% If the entry doesn't fit in one line
5297 \ifdim\dimen@ >
0.8\dimen@ii
% due to long index text
5298 \dimen@ =
0.7\dimen@
% Try to split the text roughly evenly
5300 \advance \dimen@ii by -
1em
5301 \ifnum\dimen@>
\dimen@ii
5302 % If the entry is too long, use the whole line
5305 \advance\leftskip by
0pt plus
1fill
% ragged right
5306 \advance \dimen@ by
1\rightskip
5307 \parshape =
2 0pt
\dimen@
1em
\dimen@ii
5308 % Ideally we'd add a finite glue at the end of the first line only, but
5309 % TeX doesn't seem to provide a way to do such a thing.
5313 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
5314 \finalhyphendemerits =
0
5316 % Word spacing - no stretch
5317 \spaceskip=
\fontdimen2\font minus
\fontdimen4\font
5319 \linepenalty=
1000 % Discourage line breaks.
5320 \hyphenpenalty=
5000 % Discourage hyphenation.
5322 \par % format the paragraph
5326 % delay text of entry until after penalty
5327 \bgroup\aftergroup\insertindexentrybox
5331 \newskip\thinshrinkable
5332 \skip\thinshrinkable=
.15em minus
.15em
5334 \newbox\entryindexbox
5335 \def\insertindexentrybox{%
5336 \lineskip=
.7ex plus
.5ex
% This comes into effect when the \vbox has a large
5337 % height due to the paragraph in it having several
5341 % Default is no penalty
5342 \let\entryorphanpenalty\egroup
5344 % Used from \printindex. \firsttoken should be the first token
5345 % after the \entry. If it's not another \entry, we are at the last
5346 % line of a group of index entries, so insert a penalty to discourage
5347 % orphaned index entries.
5348 \long\def\indexorphanpenalty{%
5349 \def\isentry{\entry}%
5350 \ifx\firsttoken\isentry
5352 \unskip\penalty 9000
5353 % The \unskip here stops breaking before the glue. It relies on the
5354 % \vskip above being there, otherwise there is an error
5355 % "You can't use `\unskip' in vertical mode". There has to be glue
5356 % in the current vertical list that hasn't been added to the
5357 % "current page". See Chapter 24 of the TeXbook. This contradicts
5358 % Section 8.3.7 in "TeX by Topic," though.
5360 \egroup % now comes the box added with \aftergroup
5363 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
5364 % The filll stretch here overpowers both the fil and fill stretch to push
5365 % the page number to the right.
5366 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
5367 \hbox{$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\mkern1.5mu.
\mkern1.5mu$
}\hskip 1em plus
1filll
}
5370 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
5372 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=
0.5cm
5373 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
5378 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
5380 \pdfgettoks#2.\
\the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5387 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
5388 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
5389 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
5393 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
5394 \newdimen\doublecolumntopgap
5395 \doublecolumntopgap =
0pt
5397 \newtoks\savedtopmark % Used in \begindoublecolumns
5398 \newtoks\savedfirstmark
5400 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
5401 % Grab any single-column material above us.
5404 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
5405 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
5406 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
5407 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
5408 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
5409 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
5410 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
5411 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
5412 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
5415 \global\setbox\partialpage =
\vbox{%
5416 % Unvbox the main output page.
5418 \kern-
\topskip \kern\baselineskip
5420 % Save \topmark and \firstmark
5421 \global\savedtopmark=
\expandafter{\topmark}%
5422 \global\savedfirstmark=
\expandafter{\firstmark}%
5424 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
5426 % We recover the two marks that the last output routine saved in order
5427 % to propagate the information in marks added around a chapter heading,
5428 % which could be otherwise be lost by the time the final page is output.
5430 \mark{\the\savedtopmark}% Only mark in page passed to following \output.
5432 \setbox0=
\box\PAGE % clear box 255
5435 \mark{\the\savedfirstmark}%
5437 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
5438 \output =
{\doublecolumnout}%
5440 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
5441 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
5442 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
5443 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
5444 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
5446 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
5447 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
5448 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
5449 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
5450 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
5452 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
5453 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
5456 \doublecolumnhsize =
\hsize
5457 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -
.04154\hsize
5458 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by
2
5459 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
5461 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
5462 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
5463 \global\doublecolumntopgap =
\topskip
5464 \global\advance\doublecolumntopgap by -
1\baselineskip
5465 \global\advance\vsize by -
1\doublecolumntopgap
5470 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
5471 % the last, which is done by \balancecolumns.
5473 \def\doublecolumnout{%
5474 \splittopskip=
\topskip \splitmaxdepth=
\maxdepth
5475 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
5476 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
5480 \advance\dimen@ by -
\ht\partialpage
5482 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
5483 \setbox0=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
\setbox2=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
5484 \onepageout\pagesofar
5486 \penalty\outputpenalty
5489 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
5490 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
5494 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
5495 \wd0=
\hsize \wd2=
\hsize
5497 \vskip\doublecolumntopgap
5498 \hbox to
\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}}%
5502 % Finished with with double columns.
5503 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
5504 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
5505 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
5506 % following situation:
5508 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
5509 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
5510 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
5511 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
5512 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
5513 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
5514 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
5515 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
5516 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
5517 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
5518 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
5519 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
5520 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
5521 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
5522 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
5523 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
5524 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
5525 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
5526 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
5528 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
5529 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
5533 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
5534 % current page, no automatic page break.
5537 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
5538 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
5539 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
5540 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
5541 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
5542 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
5543 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
5544 \global\output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
5547 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
5549 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
5550 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
5551 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
5552 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
5556 % Only called for the last of the double column material. \doublecolumnout
5558 \def\balancecolumns{%
5559 \setbox0 =
\vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
5561 \advance\dimen@ by
\topskip
5562 \advance\dimen@ by-
\baselineskip
5563 \ifdim\dimen@<
14\baselineskip
5564 % Don't split a short final column in two.
5567 \divide\dimen@ by
2 % target to split to
5569 \splittopskip =
\topskip
5570 % Loop until the second column is no higher than the first
5574 \global\setbox3 =
\copy0
5575 \global\setbox1 =
\vsplit3 to
\dimen@
5576 % Remove glue from bottom of first column to
5577 % make sure it is higher than the second.
5578 \global\setbox1 =
\vbox{\unvbox1\unpenalty\unskip}%
5580 \global\advance\dimen@ by
1pt
5583 \multiply\dimen@ii by
4
5584 \divide\dimen@ii by
5
5585 \ifdim\ht3<
\dimen@ii
5586 % Column heights are too different, so don't make their bottoms
5587 % flush with each other. The glue at the end of the second column
5588 % allows a second column to stretch, reducing the difference in
5589 % height between the two.
5590 \setbox0=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox1\vfill}%
5591 \setbox2=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox3\vskip 0pt plus
0.3\ht0}%
5593 \setbox0=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox1}%
5594 \setbox2=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox3}%
5600 \catcode`\@ =
\other
5603 \message{sectioning,
}
5604 % Chapters, sections, etc.
5606 % Let's start with @part.
5607 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
5611 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
5613 \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text
5614 \let\lastnode=
\empty % no node to associate with
5615 \writetocentry{part
}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
5616 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
5617 % This outputs a mark at the end of the page that clears \thischapter
5618 % and \thissection, as is done in \startcontents.
5619 \let\pchapsepmacro\relax
5620 \chapmacro{}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}%
5625 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
5626 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
5627 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
5628 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
5629 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
5630 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno =
10000
5632 \newcount\secno \secno=
0
5633 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=
0
5634 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=
0
5636 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
5637 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
5639 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
5640 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
5641 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
5642 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
5644 \def\appendixletter{%
5645 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A
%
5646 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B
%
5647 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C
%
5648 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D
%
5649 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E
%
5650 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F
%
5651 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G
%
5652 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H
%
5653 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I
%
5654 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J
%
5655 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K
%
5656 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L
%
5657 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M
%
5658 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N
%
5659 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O
%
5660 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P
%
5661 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q
%
5662 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R
%
5663 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S
%
5664 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T
%
5665 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U
%
5666 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V
%
5667 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W
%
5668 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X
%
5669 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y
%
5670 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z
%
5671 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
5672 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
5673 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
5674 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
5675 \else\char\the\appendixno
5676 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
5677 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
5679 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
5680 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
5681 % these. @section does likewise.
5683 \def\thischapternum{}
5684 \def\thischaptername{}
5686 \def\thissectionnum{}
5687 \def\thissectionname{}
5689 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
5690 \newcount\secbase\secbase=
0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
5692 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
5693 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -
1}
5694 \let\up=
\raisesections % original BFox name
5696 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
5697 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by
1}
5698 \let\down=
\lowersections % original BFox name
5700 % we only have subsub.
5701 \chardef\maxseclevel =
3
5703 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
5704 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
5705 \chardef\unnlevel =
\maxseclevel
5707 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
5708 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
5709 \def\chapheadtype{N
}
5711 % Choose a heading macro
5712 % #1 is heading type
5713 % #2 is heading level
5714 % #3 is text for heading
5715 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
5716 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
5718 \advance\absseclevel by
\secbase
5719 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
5720 \ifnum \absseclevel <
0
5723 \ifnum \absseclevel >
3
5730 \ifnum \absseclevel <
\unnlevel
5731 \chardef\unnlevel =
\absseclevel
5734 % Check for appendix sections:
5735 \ifnum \absseclevel =
0
5736 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
5738 \if \headtype A
\if \chapheadtype N
%
5739 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter
}%
5742 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
5743 \ifnum \absseclevel >
\unnlevel
5746 \chardef\unnlevel =
3
5749 % Now print the heading:
5753 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
5754 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5755 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5761 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
5762 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
5763 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5769 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5770 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5774 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5778 \def\numhead{\genhead N
}
5779 \def\apphead{\genhead A
}
5780 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U
}
5782 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
5783 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
5785 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
5786 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
5787 \let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
5789 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
5791 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
5792 % as an @include file.
5793 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
5794 \global\advance\chapno by
1
5797 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.
}%
5800 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
5801 \toks0=
\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
5802 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
5804 % Write the actual heading.
5805 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno}%
5807 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
5808 \global\let\section =
\numberedsec
5809 \global\let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
5810 \global\let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
5813 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
5815 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
5816 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
5817 \global\advance\appendixno by
1
5818 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.
}%
5821 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
5822 \toks0=
\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
5823 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
5825 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter}%
5827 \global\let\section =
\appendixsec
5828 \global\let\subsection =
\appendixsubsec
5829 \global\let\subsubsection =
\appendixsubsubsec
5832 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
5833 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
5834 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
5835 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
5836 \global\advance\unnumberedno by
1
5838 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
5839 \global\let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
5842 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
5843 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
5844 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
5845 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
5846 % to be executed, not expanded).
5848 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
5849 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
5850 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
5851 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
5854 \message{(
\the\toks0)
}%
5856 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno}%
5858 \global\let\section =
\unnumberedsec
5859 \global\let\subsection =
\unnumberedsubsec
5860 \global\let\subsubsection =
\unnumberedsubsubsec
5863 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
5864 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
5865 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\centerparameters
5867 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
5870 % @top is like @unnumbered.
5875 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
5877 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
5878 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno}%
5881 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
5882 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
5883 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
5884 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
5885 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter.
\the\secno}%
5887 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
5889 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
5890 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
5891 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
5892 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
5893 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno}%
5898 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
5899 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
5900 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
5901 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
5902 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
5905 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
5906 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
5907 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
5908 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
5909 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yappendix
}%
5910 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
5913 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
5914 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
5915 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
5916 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
5917 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynothing
}%
5918 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
5923 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
5924 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
5925 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5926 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5927 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynumbered
}%
5928 {\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5931 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
5932 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
5933 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
5934 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5935 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yappendix
}%
5936 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5939 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
5940 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
5941 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5942 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5943 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynothing
}%
5944 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5947 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
5948 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
5949 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
5950 \let\section =
\numberedsec
5951 \let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
5952 \let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
5954 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
5957 {\advance\chapheadingskip by
10pt
\chapbreak }%
5958 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
5961 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
5962 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
5963 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
5964 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
5965 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5968 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
5969 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5970 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5971 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5972 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5973 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5974 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5976 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
5977 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
5978 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
5980 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
5981 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<
#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
5983 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
5984 \newskip\chapheadingskip
5986 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
5987 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-
4000}}
5990 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
5992 % \chapoddpage - start on an odd page for a new chapter
5993 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
5994 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
5995 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
6007 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG
#1\endcsname}
6010 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
6011 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapbreak
6012 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager}
6015 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
6016 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chappager
6017 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager
6018 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
6021 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
6022 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapoddpage
6023 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chapoddpage
6024 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
6028 % \chapmacro - Chapter opening.
6030 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
6031 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
6032 % Not used for @heading series.
6034 % To test against our argument.
6035 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing
}
6036 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix
}
6037 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc
}
6039 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
6040 \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
6042 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6043 \let\prevchapterdefs=
\lastchapterdefs
6044 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
6045 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6046 \gdef\thissection{}}%
6049 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6050 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6051 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
6052 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6053 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6054 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
6055 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6057 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6058 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6059 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
6060 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
6061 % commands in some of the translations.
6062 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
6063 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6064 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6068 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6069 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6070 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
6071 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
6072 % commands in some of the translations.
6073 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
6074 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6075 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6079 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6080 % the preceding space.
6083 % Insert the chapter heading break.
6086 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6087 % between here and the heading.
6088 \let\prevchapterdefs=
\lastchapterdefs
6089 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
6093 \chapfonts \rmisbold
6094 \let\footnote=
\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
6096 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
6097 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
6098 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
6099 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6101 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
6102 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
6103 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6105 \def\toctype{unnchap
}%
6106 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6107 \setbox0 =
\hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
6109 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6110 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
6113 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#3\enspace}%
6114 \def\toctype{numchap
}%
6117 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
6118 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
6119 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
6120 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
6122 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
6123 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
6124 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
6125 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
6126 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
6129 % Typeset the actual heading.
6130 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
6131 \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=
\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
6134 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
6138 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
6139 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
6140 \def\centerparameters{%
6141 \advance\rightskip by
3\rightskip
6142 \leftskip =
\rightskip
6147 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
6148 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
6150 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF
#1\endcsname}
6152 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
6154 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
6155 \nobreak\bigskip\nobreak
6157 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
6158 \vbox to
3in
{\vfil \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
6161 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
6163 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings \hfill #1\hfill}%
6164 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
6167 \global\let\chapmacro=
\chfopen
6168 \global\let\centerchapmacro=
\centerchfopen}
6171 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
6172 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
6174 \newskip\secheadingskip
6175 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-
1000}}
6177 % Subsection titles.
6178 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
6179 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-
500}}
6181 % Subsubsection titles.
6182 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
6183 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
6186 % Print any size, any type, section title.
6188 % #1 is the text of the title,
6189 % #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
6190 % #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
6191 % #4 is the section number.
6193 \def\seckeyword{sec
}
6195 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
6197 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
6200 % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
6201 % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
6202 % dubious), but not the others.
6203 \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
6204 \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
6206 \let\footnote=
\errfootnoteheading
6208 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
6209 \csname #2fonts
\endcsname \rmisbold
6211 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6212 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
6213 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6214 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6215 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6216 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
6218 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6219 % Don't redefine \thissection.
6220 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6221 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6223 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6224 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6225 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6226 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6227 % commands in some of the translations.
6228 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6229 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6230 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6234 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6236 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6237 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6238 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6239 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6240 % commands in some of the translations.
6241 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6242 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6243 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6248 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
6249 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
6250 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
6253 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6254 % the preceding space.
6257 % Insert space above the heading.
6258 \csname #2headingbreak
\endcsname
6260 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6261 % between here and the heading.
6262 \global\let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
6265 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
6266 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6269 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6270 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6271 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
6272 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
6275 \let\sectionlevel=
\empty
6276 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6277 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
6279 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6281 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
6283 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6286 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
6287 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
6289 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
6290 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
6293 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
6294 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
6295 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
6296 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
6297 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
6298 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
6301 % Output the actual section heading.
6302 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000 \tolerance=
5000 \parindent=
0pt
\ptexraggedright
6303 \hangindent=
\wd0 % zero if no section number
6306 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
6307 % Don't allow stretch, though.
6308 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip
\endcsname
6310 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
6311 % was followed by glue.
6314 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
6315 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
6316 % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
6317 % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
6318 % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
6319 % obscuring the section heading with something else.
6322 % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
6323 % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
6324 % and do the needful.
6330 % Table of contents.
6333 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
6334 % Called from @chapter, etc.
6336 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
6337 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
6338 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
6339 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
6340 % destination to jump to.
6342 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
6343 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
6344 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
6345 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
6347 \newif\iftocfileopened
6348 \def\omitkeyword{omit
}%
6350 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
6351 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
6352 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
6353 \iftocfileopened\else
6354 \immediate\openout\tocfile =
\jobname.toc
6355 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
6361 \write\tocfile{@
#1entry
{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
6367 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
6368 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
6369 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
6370 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
6371 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
6372 % `1', and two named `2'.
6373 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
6377 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
6378 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
6379 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
6381 \def\activecatcodes{%
6394 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
6398 \input \tocreadfilename
6401 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=
1in
6402 \newcount\savepageno
6403 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -
1
6405 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
6407 \def\startcontents#1{%
6408 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
6409 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
6410 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
6411 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
6413 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
6415 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
6416 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
6417 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}%
6419 \savepageno =
\pageno
6420 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
6421 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
6422 \entryrightmargin=
\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
6424 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
6425 \ifnum \pageno>
0 \global\pageno =
\lastnegativepageno \fi
6428 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
6429 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
6431 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc
}
6433 % Normal (long) toc.
6436 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
6437 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6442 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6448 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
6449 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
6452 % And just the chapters.
6453 \def\summarycontents{%
6454 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
6456 \let\partentry =
\shortpartentry
6457 \let\numchapentry =
\shortchapentry
6458 \let\appentry =
\shortchapentry
6459 \let\unnchapentry =
\shortunnchapentry
6460 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
6462 \let\rm=
\shortcontrm \let\bf=
\shortcontbf
6463 \let\sl=
\shortcontsl \let\tt=
\shortconttt
6465 \hyphenpenalty =
10000
6466 \advance\baselineskip by
1pt
% Open it up a little.
6467 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{}
6468 \let\appsecentry =
\numsecentry
6469 \let\unnsecentry =
\numsecentry
6470 \let\numsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6471 \let\appsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6472 \let\unnsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6473 \let\numsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6474 \let\appsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6475 \let\unnsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6476 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6482 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6484 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
6485 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
6487 \let\shortcontents =
\summarycontents
6489 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
6490 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
6492 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
6493 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
6494 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
6495 % But use \hss just in case.
6496 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
6497 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
6499 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
6500 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
6501 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
6502 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
6503 % there are before deciding ...
6504 \hbox to
1em
{#1\hss}%
6507 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
6508 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
6509 % The last argument is the page number.
6510 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
6512 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
6513 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
6514 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
6515 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=
\hbox{8}\hbox to
\wd0{\hfil}}
6516 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}}
6518 % Parts, in the short toc.
6519 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
6521 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus
.15\baselineskip minus
.1\baselineskip
6522 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
6525 % Chapters, in the main contents.
6526 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6528 % Chapters, in the short toc.
6529 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
6530 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
6531 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
6534 % Appendices, in the main contents.
6535 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
6537 \def\appendixbox#1{%
6538 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
6539 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M
}%
6540 \hbox to
\wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
6542 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\hskip.7em
#1}{#4}}
6544 % Unnumbered chapters.
6545 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
6546 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
6549 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6550 \let\appsecentry=
\numsecentry
6551 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
6554 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6555 \let\appsubsecentry=
\numsubsecentry
6556 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6558 % And subsubsections.
6559 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6560 \let\appsubsubsecentry=
\numsubsubsecentry
6561 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6563 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
6564 % Same as \defaultparindent.
6565 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent =
15pt
6567 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
6570 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
6571 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
6572 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
6573 \penalty-
300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus
.33\baselineskip minus
.25\baselineskip
6575 % Move the page numbers slightly to the right
6576 \advance\entryrightmargin by -
0.05em
6578 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6580 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
6583 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6584 \secentryfonts \leftskip=
\tocindent
6585 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6588 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6589 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=
2\tocindent
6590 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6593 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6594 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=
3\tocindent
6595 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6598 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
6599 \let\tocentry =
\entry
6601 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
6602 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
6604 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6605 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6607 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
6608 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
6609 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6610 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6613 \message{environments,
}
6614 % @foo ... @end foo.
6616 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
6617 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
6618 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
6621 \setupmarkupstyle{tex
}%
6622 \catcode `\\=
0 \catcode `\
{=
1 \catcode `\
}=
2
6623 \catcode `\$=
3 \catcode `\&=
4 \catcode `\#=
6
6624 \catcode `\^=
7 \catcode `
\_=
8 \catcode `\~=
\active \let~=
\tie
6635 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
6636 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
6639 % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
6641 \let\bullet=
\ptexbullet
6646 \let\equiv=
\ptexequiv
6649 \let\indent=
\ptexindent
6650 \let\noindent=
\ptexnoindent
6657 %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
6659 \expandafter \let\csname top
\endcsname=
\ptextop % we've made it outer
6660 \let\frenchspacing=
\plainfrenchspacing
6662 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
6663 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\endldots\,$
\fi}%
6666 % There is no need to define \Etex.
6668 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
6669 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
6670 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
6672 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
6673 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=
0.4in
6675 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
6676 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
6678 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
6680 % This space is always present above and below environments.
6681 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount =
0pt
6683 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
6684 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
6685 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
6686 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
6688 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
6689 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
6690 % \sectionheading, q.v.
6691 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else
6692 \advance\envskipamount by
\parskip
6694 \ifdim\lastskip<
\envskipamount
6696 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000
6697 % Penalize breaking before the environment, because preceding text
6698 % often leads into it.
6701 \vskip\envskipamount
6706 \def\afterenvbreak{{%
6707 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
6708 % \sectionheading, q.v.
6709 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else
6710 \advance\envskipamount by
\parskip
6712 \ifdim\lastskip<
\envskipamount
6714 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
6716 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \penalty-
50 \fi
6717 \vskip\envskipamount
6722 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
6723 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
6724 \let\nonarrowing=
\relax
6726 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
6727 % environment contents.
6728 \font\circle=lcircle10
6730 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
6731 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
6732 \circthick=
\fontdimen8\circle
6734 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'
013\hskip -
6pt
}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
6735 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
010}}
6736 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'
012\hskip -
6pt
}}
6737 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
011}}
6738 \def\carttop{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6739 \ctl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\ctr
6741 \def\cartbot{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6742 \cbl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\cbr
6745 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
6748 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
6750 \lskip=
\leftskip \rskip=
\rightskip
6751 \leftskip=
0pt
\rightskip=
0pt
% we want these *outside*.
6752 \cartinner=
\hsize \advance\cartinner by-
\lskip
6753 \advance\cartinner by-
\rskip
6755 \advance\cartouter by
18.4pt
% allow for 3pt kerns on either
6756 % side, and for 6pt waste from
6757 % each corner char, and rule thickness
6758 \normbskip=
\baselineskip \normpskip=
\parskip \normlskip=
\lineskip
6760 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
6761 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
6762 % collide with the section heading.
6763 \ifnum\lastpenalty>
10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
6765 \setbox\groupbox=
\vbox\bgroup
6766 \baselineskip=
0pt
\parskip=
0pt
\lineskip=
0pt
6774 \baselineskip=
\normbskip
6775 \lineskip=
\normlskip
6778 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
6794 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
6796 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
6799 \ifdim\hfuzz <
12pt
\hfuzz =
12pt
\fi % Don't be fussy
6800 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
6801 \let\par =
\lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
6802 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
6804 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
6805 % the normal \indent.
6806 \nonfillparindent=
\parindent
6808 \let\indent\nonfillindent
6810 \emergencystretch =
0pt
% don't try to avoid overfull boxes
6811 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6812 \advance \leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
6813 \exdentamount=
\lispnarrowing
6815 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
6817 \let\exdent=
\nofillexdent
6822 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
6823 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
6824 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
6826 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
6827 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
6829 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
6831 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
6835 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
6836 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to
\nonfillparindent{\hss}}
6838 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
6839 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
6840 % This affects the following displayed environments:
6841 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
6843 \def\smallword{small
}
6844 \def\nosmallword{nosmall
}
6845 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
6846 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
6847 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
6848 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
6849 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
6850 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
6851 % to change the fonts afterward.
6852 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6853 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6856 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
6857 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
6859 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6860 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6864 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
6865 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
6866 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
6867 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
6868 \expandafter\envdef\csname small
#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
6869 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6870 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6873 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
6874 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
6875 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
6876 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
6879 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
6880 % @example: same as @lisp.
6882 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
6883 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
6885 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp
}{example
}{%
6887 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example
}%
6888 \let\kbdfont =
\kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
6889 \gobble % eat return
6891 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
6893 \makedispenvdef{display
}{%
6898 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
6900 \makedispenvdef{format
}{%
6901 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6906 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
6908 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6912 \let\Eflushleft =
\afterenvbreak
6916 \envdef\flushright{%
6917 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6919 \advance\leftskip by
0pt plus
1fill
\relax
6922 \let\Eflushright =
\afterenvbreak
6925 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
6926 % justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special
6927 % characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right
6929 \envdef\raggedright{%
6930 \rightskip0pt plus2.4em
\spaceskip.3333em
\xspaceskip.5em
\relax
6931 \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt
}%
6932 \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt
}%
6934 \let\Eraggedright\par
6936 \envdef\raggedleft{%
6937 \parindent=
0pt
\leftskip0pt plus2em
6938 \spaceskip.3333em
\xspaceskip.5em
\parfillskip=
0pt
6939 \hbadness=
10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6940 % badness reporting.
6942 \let\Eraggedleft\par
6944 \envdef\raggedcenter{%
6945 \parindent=
0pt
\rightskip0pt plus1em
\leftskip0pt plus1em
6946 \spaceskip.3333em
\xspaceskip.5em
\parfillskip=
0pt
6947 \hbadness=
10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6948 % badness reporting.
6950 \let\Eraggedcenter\par
6953 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
6954 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
6955 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
6956 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
6958 \makedispenvdef{quotation
}{\quotationstart}
6960 \def\quotationstart{%
6961 \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
6962 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6963 \advance\rightskip by
\lispnarrowing
6965 \parsearg\quotationlabel
6968 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
6969 % doing normal filling.
6973 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
6975 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---
\quotationauthor}%
6977 {\parskip=
0pt
\afterenvbreak}%
6979 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
6981 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
6982 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
6984 \ifx\temp\empty \else
6989 % @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
6990 % has no optional argument.
6992 \makedispenvdef{indentedblock
}{\indentedblockstart}
6994 \def\indentedblockstart{%
6995 {\parskip=
0pt
\aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
6998 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
6999 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7000 \advance\leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
7001 \exdentamount =
\lispnarrowing
7003 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
7007 % Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
7009 \def\Eindentedblock{%
7011 {\parskip=
0pt
\afterenvbreak}%
7013 \def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
7016 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
7017 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
7018 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
7019 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
7021 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
7023 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
7024 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
7027 \do\
\do\\
\do\
{\do\
}\do\$
\do\&
%
7028 \do\#
\do\^
\do\^^K
\do\_\do\^^A
\do\%
\do\~
%
7029 \do\<
\do\>
\do\|
\do\@
\do+
\do\"
%
7030 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
7031 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
7032 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
7037 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
7038 \def\do#
#1{\catcode`#
#1=
\other}\dospecials}
7040 % Setup for the @verb command.
7042 % Eight spaces for a tab
7044 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
7045 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=
\active\def^^I
{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \
}}
7049 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7050 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
7051 \setupmarkupstyle{verb
}%
7053 % Respect line breaks,
7054 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7055 % make each space count
7056 % must do in this order:
7057 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7060 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
7062 % Real tab expansion.
7063 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=
\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=
8\wd0 % tab amount
7065 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
7066 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
7067 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
7068 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
7069 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
7070 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
7072 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=
\hbox\bgroup}
7075 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
7077 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
7078 \def^^I
{\leavevmode\egroup
7079 \dimen\verbbox=
\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
7080 \divide\dimen\verbbox by
\tabw
7081 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by
\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
7082 \advance\dimen\verbbox by
\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
7083 \wd\verbbox=
\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
7088 % start the verbatim environment.
7089 \def\setupverbatim{%
7090 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
7092 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7093 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
7094 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
7095 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
7097 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim
}%
7098 % Respect line breaks,
7099 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7100 % make each space count.
7101 % Must do in this order:
7102 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7103 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
7106 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
7107 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
7108 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
7110 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
7112 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
7114 \catcode`
[=
1\catcode`
]=
2\catcode`\
{=
\other\catcode`\
}=
\other
7115 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next#
#1#1}[#
#1\endgroup]\next]
7118 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
7121 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
7122 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
7124 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
7126 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
7127 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
7128 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
7130 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
7135 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
7136 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
7137 % line in the output.
7138 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M
#2@end verbatim
{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim
}%
7139 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
7140 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
7144 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
7146 \let\Everbatim =
\afterenvbreak
7149 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
7151 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
7153 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
7155 \makevalueexpandable
7157 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
7158 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of
#1^^J
}%
7164 % @copying ... @end copying.
7165 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
7167 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
7168 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
7169 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
7170 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
7171 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
7172 % possible is desirable.
7174 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
7175 \def\docopying#1@end copying
{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
7177 \def\insertcopying{%
7179 \parindent =
0pt
% paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
7180 \scanexp\copyingtext
7188 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=
.4in
7189 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=
50pt
7190 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=
18pt
7191 \newcount\defunpenalty
7193 % Start the processing of @deffn:
7195 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000
7197 \defunpenalty=
10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
7198 % following @def command, see below.
7200 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
7201 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
7202 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
7203 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
7204 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
7205 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
7206 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
7208 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
7209 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
7210 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
7212 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
7214 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
7215 % But do insert the glue.
7216 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
7220 \advance\leftskip by
\defbodyindent
7221 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
7225 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
7228 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
7229 % It's not a great place, though.
7230 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
7232 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
7233 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
7235 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
7237 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
7239 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
7241 % call \deffnheader:
7244 \interlinepenalty =
10000
7245 \advance\rightskip by
0pt plus
1fil
\relax
7247 \nobreak\vskip -
\parskip
7248 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
7249 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
7250 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
7255 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
7257 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
7258 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
7261 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname =
\Edefun
7262 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
7263 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x
}\makecsname{#1header
}}%
7267 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader { (defn. of \deffnheader) }
7269 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
7270 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
7272 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
7275 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
7276 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
7278 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
7282 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
7283 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
7285 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
7286 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
7287 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
7289 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
7292 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl
\endcsname
7294 \else\ifx\temp\offword
7295 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl
\endcsname
7298 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
7299 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `
\temp',
7304 % Untyped functions:
7306 % @deffn category name args
7307 \makedefun{deffn
}{\deffngeneral{}}
7309 % @deffn category class name args
7310 \makedefun{defop
}#1 {\defopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
7312 % \defopon {category on}class name args
7313 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
7315 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
7317 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
7318 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
7319 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
7320 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
7325 % @deftypefn category type name args
7326 \makedefun{deftypefn
}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
7328 % @deftypeop category class type name args
7329 \makedefun{deftypeop
}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
7331 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
7332 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
7334 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
7336 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7337 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7339 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7344 % @deftypevr category type var args
7345 \makedefun{deftypevr
}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
7347 % @deftypecv category class type var args
7348 \makedefun{deftypecv
}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
7350 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
7351 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
7353 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
7355 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7356 \dosubind{vr
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7357 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7360 % Untyped variables:
7362 % @defvr category var args
7363 \makedefun{defvr
}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
7365 % @defcv category class var args
7366 \makedefun{defcv
}#1 {\defcvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
7368 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
7369 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
7373 % @deftp category name args
7374 \makedefun{deftp
}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
7375 \doind{tp
}{\code{#2}}%
7376 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
7379 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
7380 \makedefun{defun
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7381 \makedefun{defmac
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
7382 \makedefun{defspec
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
7383 \makedefun{deftypefun
}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7384 \makedefun{defvar
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7385 \makedefun{defopt
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
7386 \makedefun{deftypevar
}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7387 \makedefun{defmethod
}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
7388 \makedefun{deftypemethod
}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
7389 \makedefun{defivar
}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7390 \makedefun{deftypeivar
}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7392 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
7393 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
7394 % #2 is the return type, if any.
7395 % #3 is the function name.
7397 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
7399 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
7401 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
7402 \advance\leftskip by -
\defbodyindent
7404 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
7405 % on a line by itself.
7406 \rettypeownlinefalse
7407 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
7408 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
7409 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl
\endcsname\relax \else
7414 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
7415 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
7418 \setbox0=
\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
7420 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
7424 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
7425 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
7426 \dimen0=
\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by
\rightskip
7428 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
7430 \advance\tempnum by
1
7431 \def\maybeshapeline{0in
\hsize}%
7433 \def\maybeshapeline{}%
7436 % The continuations:
7437 \dimen2=
\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -
\defargsindent
7439 % The final paragraph shape:
7440 \parshape \tempnum 0in
\dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
7442 % Put the category name at the right margin.
7445 \hfil\box0 \kern-
\hsize
7446 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
7448 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
7451 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
7452 \tolerance=
10000 \hbadness=
10000
7453 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
7455 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
7456 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
7457 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
7458 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
7459 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
7460 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
7461 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
7462 % one has made identifiers using them :).
7464 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
7465 \ifx\temp\empty\else
7466 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
7468 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
7469 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
7471 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
7473 \fi % no return type
7474 #3% output function name
7476 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
7479 % arguments will be output next, if any.
7482 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
7483 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
7484 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
7485 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
7488 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
7490 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=
0
7492 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
7493 % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
7494 % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
7495 % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
7496 % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
7497 \def\var#
#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var
}\ttslanted{#
#1}}}%
7499 \sl\hyphenchar\font=
45
7502 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
7505 \catcode`\(=
\active \catcode`\)=
\active
7506 \catcode`\
[=
\active \catcode`\
]=
\active
7510 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
7511 \let\lparen = (
\let\rparen = )
7513 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
7514 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
7515 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
7518 \global\let(=
\lparen \global\let)=
\rparen
7519 \global\let[=
\lbrack \global\let]=
\rbrack
7522 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=
\opnr\let)=
\clnr\let[=
\lbrb\let]=
\rbrb}
7523 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=
\amprm}
7526 \newcount\parencount
7528 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
7530 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&
#1 }}
7534 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
7535 % otherwise use the default font.
7536 \ifnum \parencount=
1 \rm \fi
7538 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
7539 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
7543 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
7550 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
7553 \global\advance\parencount by
1
7555 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
7560 \global\advance\parencount by -
1
7563 \newcount\brackcount
7565 \global\advance\brackcount by
1
7570 \global\advance\brackcount by -
1
7573 \def\checkparencounts{%
7574 \ifnum\parencount=
0 \else \badparencount \fi
7575 \ifnum\brackcount=
0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
7577 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
7578 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
7579 \def\badparencount{%
7580 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...
}%
7581 \global\parencount=
0
7583 \def\badbrackcount{%
7584 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...
}%
7585 \global\brackcount=
0
7592 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
7593 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
7594 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7595 \newwrite\macscribble
7598 \immediate\openout\macscribble=
\jobname.tmp
7599 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
7600 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
7605 \let\aftermacroxxx\relax
7606 \def\aftermacro{\aftermacroxxx}
7608 % alias because \c means cedilla in @tex or @math
7611 % Used at the time of macro expansion.
7612 % Argument is macro body with arguments substituted
7615 % Reduce doubled backslashes to one
7616 \def\xprocessmacroarg{\passargtomacro\eatspaces}%
7618 % Process the macro body under the current catcode regime.
7619 \scantokens{#1\texinfoc}\aftermacro%
7621 % The \c is to remove the \newlinechar added by \scantokens, and
7622 % can be noticed by \parsearg.
7623 % The \aftermacro allows a \comment at the end of the macro definition
7624 % to duplicate itself past the final \newlinechar added by \scantokens:
7625 % this is used in the definition of \group to comment out a newline. We
7626 % don't do the same for \c to support Texinfo files with macros that ended
7627 % with a @c, which should no longer be necessary.
7628 % We avoid surrounding the call to \scantokens with \bgroup and \egroup
7629 % to allow macros to open or close groups themselves.
7634 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \printindex
7635 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
7636 % backslash to get it printed correctly.
7637 % FIXME: This may not be needed.
7638 %\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
7639 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
7644 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
7645 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
7646 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
7648 % List of all defined macros in the form
7649 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
7650 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
7651 % if there is a need.
7654 % Add the macro to \macrolist
7655 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
7656 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
7657 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
7658 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
7662 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
7663 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
7664 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
7668 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
7672 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
7673 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
7675 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@
\expandafter{#1 }}
7676 \gdef\trim@
#1{\trim@@ @
#1 @
#1 @ @@
}
7677 \gdef\trim@@
#1@
#2@
#3@@
{\trim@@@
\empty #2 @
}
7679 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@
#1 } #2@
{#1}
7682 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
7683 {\catcode`\^^M=
\other \catcode`
\Q=
3%
7684 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ
}%
7685 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ
{\eatcrb#1Q
}%
7686 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q
#2Q
{#1}%
7689 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
7690 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
7691 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
7692 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
7694 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
7695 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
7696 % confine the change to the current group.
7698 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
7699 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
7700 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
7702 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
7711 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
7714 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
7718 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
7721 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
7727 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
7731 % Used when scanning braced macro arguments. Note, however, that catcode
7732 % changes here are ineffectual if the macro invocation was nested inside
7733 % an argument to another Texinfo command.
7736 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
7740 \def\macrolineargctxt{% used for whole-line arguments without braces
7746 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
7747 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
7748 % where N is the macro parameter number.
7749 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
7750 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
7752 {\catcode`@=
0 @catcode`@\=@active
7753 @gdef@usembodybackslash
{@let\=@mbodybackslash
}
7754 @gdef@mbodybackslash
#1\
{@csname macarg.
#1@endcsname
}
7756 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.
\endcsname{\realbackslash}
7758 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\
#1 }
7760 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
7761 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
7764 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
7765 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
7768 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;
%
7769 \if\paramno>
256\relax
7770 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7771 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
7772 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than
256 arguments
}
7776 \if1\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname
7777 \message{Warning: redefining
\the\macname}%
7779 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
7780 \else \errmessage{Macro name
\the\macname\space already defined
}\fi
7781 \global\cslet{macsave.
\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
7782 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname=
1%
7783 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
7785 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
7786 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
7787 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
7790 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
7791 \if1\csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname
7792 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}%
7793 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname=
0%
7794 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
7796 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
7797 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
7798 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
7801 \errmessage{Macro
#1 not defined
}%
7805 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
7806 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
7812 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
7816 % \getargs -- Parse the arguments to a @macro line. Set \macname to
7817 % the name of the macro, and \argl to the braced argument list.
7818 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
7819 \def\getargsxxx#1#
{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
7820 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname=
{#1}}
7821 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
7822 % This made use of the feature that if the last token of a
7823 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
7824 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
7826 % Parse the optional {params} list to @macro or @rmacro.
7827 % Set \paramno to the number of arguments,
7828 % and \paramlist to a parameter text for the macro (e.g. #1,#2,#3 for a
7829 % three-param macro.) Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH in the params
7830 % list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If there are
7831 % less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
7832 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
7833 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
7835 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
7837 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used: see
7838 % \parsemmanyargdef.
7840 \def\parsemargdef#1;
{%
7841 \paramno=
0\def\paramlist{}%
7843 % \hash is redefined to `#' later to get it into definitions
7844 \let\processmacroarg\relax
7845 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,
%
7846 \ifnum\paramno<
10\relax\else
7848 \parsemmanyargdef@@
#1,;,
% 10 or more arguments
7851 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,
{%
7852 \if#1;
\let\next=
\relax
7853 \else \let\next=
\parsemargdefxxx
7854 \advance\paramno by
1
7855 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.
\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
7856 {\processmacroarg{\hash\the\paramno}}%
7857 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,
}%
7860 % \parsemacbody, \parsermacbody
7862 % Read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. (They're different since
7863 % rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
7865 % We are in \macrobodyctxt, and the \xdef causes backslashshes in the macro
7866 % body to be transformed.
7867 % Set \macrobody to the body of the macro, and call \defmacro.
7869 {\catcode`\ =
\other\long\gdef\parsemacbody#1@end macro
{%
7870 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
7871 {\catcode`\ =
\other\long\gdef\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro
{%
7872 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
7874 % Make @ a letter, so that we can make private-to-Texinfo macro names.
7875 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@
}
7876 \catcode `@=
11\relax
7878 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% Code for > 10 arguments only %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
7880 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
7881 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
7882 % processed again to replace the arguments.
7884 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
7885 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
7886 % the catcode regime under which the body was input).
7888 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
7889 % arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
7891 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
7892 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
7893 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
7894 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
7895 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
7896 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
7897 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@
#1,
{%
7898 \if#1;
\let\next=
\relax
7900 \let\next=
\parsemmanyargdef@@
7901 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
7902 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
7903 \expandafter{\csname macarg.
\tempb\endcsname}%
7904 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
7905 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
7907 \expandafter\edef\tempa
7908 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
7909 \advance\paramno by
1\relax
7916 \long\def\nillm@
{\nil@
}%
7918 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
7919 % definition. It gets all the arguments' values and assigns them to macros
7922 % #1 is the macro name
7923 % #2 is the list of argument names
7924 % #3 is the list of argument values
7925 \def\getargvals@
#1#2#3{%
7926 \def\macargdeflist@
{}%
7927 \def\saveparamlist@
{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
7928 \def\paramlist{#2,
\nil@
}%
7932 \def\argvaluelist{#3,
\nil@
}%
7941 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
7942 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
7943 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7945 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
7946 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `
\macroname'!
}%
7948 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
7950 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7951 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
7953 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
7955 % pop current arg name into \@tempb
7956 \def\@tempa#
#1{\pop@
{\@tempb
}{\paramlist}#
#1\endargs@
}%
7957 \expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{\paramlist}%
7958 % pop current argument value into \@tempc
7959 \def\@tempa#
#1{\longpop@
{\@tempc
}{\argvaluelist}#
#1\endargs@
}%
7960 \expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
7961 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
7962 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
7963 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc
}%
7964 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb
\endcsname\relax
7965 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe
\expandafter{%
7966 \csname macarg.\@tempb
\endcsname}%
7967 \edef\@tempd
{\long\def\@tempe
{\the\macname}}%
7968 \push@\@tempd
\macargdeflist@
7969 \let\next\getargvals@@
7976 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
7977 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
7978 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
7982 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
7985 \def\macvalstoargs@
{%
7986 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
7987 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
7988 % values into respective token registers.
7990 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
7993 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
7994 % value into a new token list register \toks#N
7995 \expandafter\putargsintokens@
\saveparamlist@,;,
%
7996 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
7997 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
7998 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
7999 \edef\@tempc
{\csname mac.
\macroname .body
\endcsname}%
8000 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
8001 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
8005 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{\@tempc
}%
8008 % Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
8010 \def\macargexpandinbody@
{%
8014 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
8017 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
8019 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb
\csname mac.
\macroname .recurse
\endcsname
8020 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
8027 % And now we do the real job:
8028 \edef\@tempd
{\noexpand\@tempb
{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa
}\@tempc
}%
8032 \def\putargsintokens@
#1,
{%
8033 \if#1;
\let\next\relax
8035 \let\next\putargsintokens@
8036 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
8038 \toksdef\@tempb
\the\paramno
8039 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
8040 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa
\csname macarg.
#1\endcsname
8041 \expandafter\@tempb
\expandafter{\@tempa
}%
8042 \advance\paramno by
1\relax
8047 % Trailing missing arguments are set to empty.
8049 \def\setemptyargvalues@
{%
8050 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
8051 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
8053 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@
\paramlist\endargs@
8054 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
8059 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@
#1,
#2\endargs@
{%
8060 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{%
8061 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.
#1\endcsname{}}%
8062 \push@\@tempa
\macargdeflist@
8066 % #1 is the element target macro
8067 % #2 is the list macro
8068 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
8069 \def\pop@
#1#2#3,
#4\endargs@
{%
8073 \long\def\longpop@
#1#2#3,
#4\endargs@
{%
8079 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% End of code for > 10 arguments %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8083 % Remove following spaces at the expansion stage.
8084 % This works because spaces are discarded before each argument when TeX is
8085 % getting the arguments for a macro.
8086 % This must not be immediately followed by a }.
8087 \long\def\gobblespaces#1{#1}
8089 % This defines a Texinfo @macro or @rmacro, called by \parsemacbody.
8090 % \macrobody has the body of the macro in it, with placeholders for
8091 % its parameters, looking like "\processmacroarg{\hash 1}".
8092 % \paramno is the number of parameters
8093 % \paramlist is a TeX parameter text, e.g. "#1,#2,#3,"
8094 % There are eight cases: recursive and nonrecursive macros of zero, one,
8095 % up to nine, and many arguments.
8096 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
8097 % they're defined in: @include reads the file inside a group.
8100 \let\hash=##
% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
8102 \def\processmacroarg{\gobblespaces}%
8103 % This removes the pair of braces around the argument. We don't
8104 % use \eatspaces, because this can cause ends of lines to be lost
8105 % when the argument to \eatspaces is read, leading to line-based
8106 % commands like "@itemize" not being read correctly.
8108 \def\processmacroarg{\xprocessmacroarg}%
8109 \let\xprocessmacroarg\relax
8111 \ifrecursive %%%%%%%%%%%%%% Recursive %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8114 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8115 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8117 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8119 \noexpand\braceorline
8120 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname}%
8121 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname#
#1{%
8122 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@
\endcsname{%
8123 \noexpand\gobblespaces#
#1\empty}%
8124 % The \empty is for \gobblespaces in case #1 is empty
8126 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@@
\endcsname#
#1{%
8127 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8129 \ifnum\paramno<
10\relax % at most 9
8130 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8131 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
8132 \noexpand\csname\the\macname @@
\endcsname}%
8133 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@
\endcsname#
#1{%
8134 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
8135 \expandafter\expandafter
8137 \expandafter\expandafter
8138 \csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname
8139 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8141 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8142 \noexpand\getargvals@
{\the\macname}{\argl}%
8144 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .body
\endcsname\macrobody
8145 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .recurse
\endcsname\gobble
8148 \else %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% Non-recursive %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8151 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8152 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8154 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8156 \noexpand\braceorline
8157 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname}%
8158 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname#
#1{%
8159 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@
\endcsname{%
8160 \noexpand\gobblespaces#
#1\empty}%
8161 % The \empty is for \gobblespaces in case #1 is empty
8163 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@@
\endcsname#
#1{%
8165 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
8168 \ifnum\paramno<
10\relax
8169 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8170 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
8171 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@
\endcsname}%
8172 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@
\endcsname#
#1{%
8173 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
8174 \expandafter\expandafter
8176 \expandafter\expandafter
8177 \csname\the\macname @@@
\endcsname
8180 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
8183 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8184 \noexpand\getargvals@
{\the\macname}{\argl}%
8186 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .body
\endcsname\macrobody
8187 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .recurse
\endcsname\norecurse
8192 \catcode `\@
\texiatcatcode\relax % end private-to-Texinfo catcodes
8194 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}}
8197 {\catcode`\@=
0 \catcode`\\=
13
8200 % Call #1 with a list of tokens #2, with any doubled backslashes in #2
8201 % compressed to one.
8202 @gdef@passargtomacro
#1#2{%
8204 @def@pending_backslash
{}%
8205 @def@finish
{@finish
}%
8207 @let@next_token=@relax
8208 @add_segment
#2\@finish\%
8211 % Input stream is just after a backslash. If the next token is not a
8212 % backslash, process the rest of the argument; otherwise, remove the next
8215 @futurelet@next_token@look_aheadzzz
}
8216 @gdef@look_aheadzzz
{%
8218 @let@next=@gobble_and_check_finish
8220 @let@next=@add_segment
8224 % Double backslash found. Add a single backslash here.
8225 @gdef@gobble_and_check_finish
#1{%
8227 @def@pending_backslash
{}%
8228 @futurelet@next_token@add_segment
8231 % append a backslash to \arg_result
8232 @gdef@add_the_backslash
{%
8233 @expandafter@gdef@expandafter@arg_result@expandafter
{@arg_result\
}%
8236 % Input stream is either at the start of the argument, or just after a
8237 % backslash sequence, either a lone backslash, or a doubled backslash.
8238 % \next_token contains the first token in the input stream: if it is \finish,
8239 % finish; otherwise, append to \arg_result the segment of the argument up until
8240 % the next backslash. \pending_backslash contains a backslash to represent
8241 % a backslash just before the start of the input stream that has not been
8242 % added to \arg_result.
8243 @gdef@add_segment
#1\
{%
8244 @ifx@next_token@finish
8245 @let@next=@call_the_macro
%
8247 @let@next=@look_ahead
8249 % append to @arg_result
8250 % token list registers might be better
8251 @expandafter@expandafter@expandafter@gdef
8252 @expandafter@expandafter@expandafter@arg_result
8253 @expandafter@expandafter@expandafter
{%
8254 @expandafter@arg_result
8255 @pending_backslash
#1}%
8256 @def@pending_backslash
{\
}%
8259 @gdef@call_the_macro
{@expandafter@the_macro@expandafter
{@arg_result
}}
8263 % \braceorline MAC is used for a one-argument macro MAC. It checks
8264 % whether the next non-whitespace character is a {. It sets the context
8265 % for reading the argument (slightly different in the two cases). Then,
8266 % to read the argument, in the whole-line case, it then calls the regular
8267 % \parsearg MAC; in the lbrace case, it calls \passargtomacro MAC.
8269 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=
#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
8270 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
8273 \expandafter\passargtomacro
8275 \macrolineargctxt\expandafter\parsearg
8280 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
8281 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
8283 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
8284 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
8285 \def\aliasyyy #1=
#2\relax{%
8287 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=
\empty
8288 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
8289 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=
\makecsname{#2}}%
8295 \message{cross references,
}
8298 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
8299 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
8301 % @inforef is relatively simple.
8302 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**
}
8303 \def\inforefzzz #1,
#2,
#3,
#4**
{%
8304 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
8305 node
\samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
8307 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
8308 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
8309 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
8310 % @node foo , bar , ...
8311 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
8313 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,
\finishnodeparse}
8315 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
8316 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
8317 \def\donode#1 ,
#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,
\finishnodeparse}
8318 \def\dodonode#1,
#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
8321 \let\lastnode=
\empty
8323 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
8324 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
8327 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
8328 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
8329 \global\let\lastnode=
\empty
8333 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
8335 \newcount\savesfregister
8337 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=
\spacefactor \fi}
8338 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=
\savesfregister \fi}
8339 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing
}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
8341 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
8342 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
8343 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
8344 % or the anchor name.
8345 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
8346 % empty for anchors.
8347 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
8349 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
8350 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
8351 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
8358 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
8359 \edef\writexrdef#
#1#
#2{%
8360 \write\auxfile{@xrdef
{#1-
% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
8361 #
#1}{#
#2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
8363 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\lastsection}%
8364 \immediate \writexrdef{title
}{\the\toks0 }%
8365 \immediate \writexrdef{snt
}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
8366 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg
}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
8371 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
8372 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
8373 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
8374 % variable, now it's official.
8376 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
8379 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname
8381 \else\ifx\temp\offword
8382 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname
8385 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
8386 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `
\temp',
8392 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
8393 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
8394 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
8395 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
8397 \def\pxref{\putwordsee{} \xrefXX}
8398 \def\xref{\putwordSee{} \xrefXX}
8401 \def\xrefXX#1{\def\xrefXXarg{#1}\futurelet\tokenafterxref\xrefXXX}
8402 \def\xrefXXX{\expandafter\xrefX\expandafter[\xrefXXarg,,,,,,,
]}
8405 \newbox\printedrefnamebox
8406 \newbox\infofilenamebox
8407 \newbox\printedmanualbox
8409 \def\xrefX[#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6]{\begingroup
8412 % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
8413 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
8414 \setbox\printedrefnamebox =
\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
8416 \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
8417 \setbox\infofilenamebox =
\hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
8419 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
8420 \setbox\printedmanualbox =
\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
8422 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
8423 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
8424 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox =
0pt
8425 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
8426 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname \relax
8427 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
8428 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8430 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
8431 % the square brackets if we have it.
8432 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox >
0pt
8433 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
8434 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8437 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
8438 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title
}{}}%
8440 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
8441 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8447 % Make link in pdf output.
8451 \makevalueexpandable
8452 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8453 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8454 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8457 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8458 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8459 \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
8460 \ifx\pdfxrefdest\empty
8461 \def\pdfxrefdest{Top
}% no empty targets
8463 \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest % escape PDF special chars
8467 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
8468 \ifnum\filenamelength>
0
8469 goto file
{\the\filename.pdf
} name
{\pdfxrefdest}%
8471 goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
8474 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8477 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
8478 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
8479 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
8481 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
8482 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
8485 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
8486 \csname XR
#1-title
\endcsname
8488 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
8489 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
8490 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
8491 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox =
0pt
8497 % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
8499 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox >
0pt
8500 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
8503 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
8505 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
8506 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
8507 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
8508 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
8509 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
8510 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
8512 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox >
0pt
8513 % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
8515 \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
8517 \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox >
0pt
8518 % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
8519 % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
8520 % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
8522 \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
8525 % Reference within this manual.
8527 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
8528 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
8529 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
8530 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
8531 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
8533 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
8534 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
8535 \setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt
}{}}%
8536 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt
\refx{#1-snt
}\space\fi
8538 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
8539 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
8541 % But we always want a comma and a space:
8544 % output the `page 3'.
8545 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg
}{}%
8546 \ifx,
\tokenafterxref
8547 \else\ifx.
\tokenafterxref
8548 \else\ifx;
\tokenafterxref
8549 \else\ifx)
\tokenafterxref
8550 \else,
% add a , if xref not followed by punctuation
8557 % Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
8559 % Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
8560 % missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
8561 % "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
8563 % But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
8564 % string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
8565 % the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
8566 % likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
8567 % in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
8569 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
8570 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
8572 \def\crossmanualxref#1{%
8573 \setbox\toprefbox =
\hbox{Top
\kern7sp}%
8574 \setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
8575 \ifdim \wd2 >
7sp
% nonempty?
8576 \ifdim \wd2 =
\wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
8577 \putwordSection{} ``
\printedrefname''
\putwordin{}\space
8583 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
8584 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
8585 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
8586 % one that Bob is working on :).
8588 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
8590 % Things referred to by \setref.
8596 \putwordChapter@tie
\the\chapno
8597 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
8598 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno
8599 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
8600 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
8602 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
8607 \putwordAppendix@tie @char
\the\appendixno{}%
8608 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
8609 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno
8610 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
8611 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
8614 @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
8618 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
8619 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
8626 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
8627 \csname XR
#1\endcsname
8630 % If not defined, say something at least.
8631 \angleleft un\-de\-fined
\angleright
8634 {\toks0 =
{#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
8635 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `
\the\toks0'.
}}%
8638 \global\warnedxrefstrue
8639 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.
}%
8644 % It's defined, so just use it.
8647 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
8650 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
8651 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
8652 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
8655 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
8656 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
8657 % mess up the control sequence name.
8660 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
8663 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
8665 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
8666 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname
8667 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
8668 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
8669 \csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname
8671 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
8672 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
8673 \toks0 =
{\do}% yes, so just \do
8675 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
8676 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
8679 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
8680 % for later use in \listoffloats.
8681 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
8686 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
8687 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
8688 % This is done with @novalidate at the beginning of the file.
8690 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
8691 \let\novalidate =
\linksfalse
8693 % Used when writing to the aux file, or when using data from it.
8694 \def\requireauxfile{%
8697 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
8698 \immediate\openout\auxfile=
\jobname.aux
8700 \global\let\requireauxfile=
\relax % Only do this once.
8703 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
8706 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
8709 \global\havexrefstrue
8714 \def\setupdatafile{%
8715 \catcode`\^^@=
\other
8716 \catcode`\^^A=
\other
8717 \catcode`\^^B=
\other
8718 \catcode`\^^C=
\other
8719 \catcode`\^^D=
\other
8720 \catcode`\^^E=
\other
8721 \catcode`\^^F=
\other
8722 \catcode`\^^G=
\other
8723 \catcode`\^^H=
\other
8724 \catcode`\^^K=
\other
8725 \catcode`\^^L=
\other
8726 \catcode`\^^N=
\other
8727 \catcode`\^^P=
\other
8728 \catcode`\^^Q=
\other
8729 \catcode`\^^R=
\other
8730 \catcode`\^^S=
\other
8731 \catcode`\^^T=
\other
8732 \catcode`\^^U=
\other
8733 \catcode`\^^V=
\other
8734 \catcode`\^^W=
\other
8735 \catcode`\^^X=
\other
8736 \catcode`\^^Z=
\other
8737 \catcode`\^^
[=
\other
8738 \catcode`\^^\=
\other
8739 \catcode`\^^
]=
\other
8740 \catcode`\^^^=
\other
8741 \catcode`\^^_=
\other
8742 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
8743 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
8744 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
8745 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
8746 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
8747 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
8748 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
8749 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
8751 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
8752 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
8753 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
8757 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
8770 \catcode`+=
\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
8772 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
8773 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
8774 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
8775 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
8776 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
8777 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
8778 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
8781 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
8782 {\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other}%
8784 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
8790 \def\readdatafile#1{%
8797 \message{insertions,
}
8798 % including footnotes.
8800 \newcount \footnoteno
8802 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
8803 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
8804 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
8805 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
8806 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
8807 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -
20000\footnoteno =
0 }
8809 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
8810 \let\footnotestyle=
\comment
8814 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
8816 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
8817 \edef\thisfootno{$^
{\the\footnoteno}$
}%
8819 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
8820 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
8822 \ifhmode\edef\@sf
{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
8824 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
8830 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
8831 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
8833 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
8834 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
8835 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
8838 \insert\footins\bgroup
8840 % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
8841 % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
8842 \let\footnote=
\errfootnotenest
8844 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
8845 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
8846 % So reset some parameters.
8848 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
8849 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
8850 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
8851 \floatingpenalty\@MM
8856 \parindent\defaultparindent
8860 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
8861 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
8862 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
8863 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
8864 \let\noindent =
\relax
8866 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
8867 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
8868 \everypar =
{\hang}%
8869 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
8871 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
8872 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
8873 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
8876 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
8877 \futurelet\next\fo@t
8879 }%end \catcode `\@=11
8881 \def\errfootnotenest{%
8883 \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
8884 even though they work in makeinfo; sorry
}
8887 \def\errfootnoteheading{%
8889 \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported
}
8892 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
8893 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
8895 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
8896 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
8897 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
8899 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
8900 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
8903 \def\startsavinginserts{%
8904 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
8905 \let\insert\saveinsert
8907 \let\checkinserts\relax
8911 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
8912 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
8915 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
8916 \afterassignment\next
8917 % swallow the left brace
8920 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE
\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
8921 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 =
\vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
8923 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
8925 \def\placesaveins#1{%
8926 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
8930 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
8932 \def\dospecials{\do S
\do A
\do V
\do E
} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
8933 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE
{}
8937 \def\newsaveins #1{%
8938 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
8941 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
8942 \csname newbox
\endcsname #1%
8943 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
8948 \let\checkinserts\empty
8953 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
8954 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
8956 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
8957 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
8958 % undone and the next image would fail.
8959 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
8961 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
8962 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
8963 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 =
}%
8968 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
8969 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
8970 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
8971 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
8972 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.
}
8975 \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
8976 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
8977 \errhelp =
\noepsfhelp
8978 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored
}%
8979 \global\warnednoepsftrue
8982 \imagexxx #1,,,,,
\finish
8986 % Arguments to @image:
8987 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
8988 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
8989 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
8990 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
8991 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
8993 \def\imagexxx#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6\finish{\begingroup
8994 \catcode`\^^M =
5 % in case we're inside an example
8995 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
8996 \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}% in case we are being used via a macro
8997 % If the image is by itself, center it.
9000 \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
9001 % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
9003 \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
9008 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
9009 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
9011 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
9015 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
9016 % environment such as @quotation is respected.
9017 % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
9018 % normal paragraph indentation.
9019 % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
9020 % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
9021 % eradicate the centering.
9022 \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
9026 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
9028 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
9029 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfxsize=
#2\relax \fi
9030 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfysize=
#3\relax \fi
9035 \medskip % space after a standalone image
9037 \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
9041 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
9042 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
9043 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
9045 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,
\finish}
9047 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
9048 \def\eatcommaspace#1,
{#1,
}
9050 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
9051 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
9052 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
9054 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
9057 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
9058 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
9060 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
9061 % chapter-level command.
9062 \let\resetallfloatnos=
\empty
9064 \def\dofloat#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{%
9065 \let\thiscaption=
\empty
9066 \let\thisshortcaption=
\empty
9068 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
9070 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
9071 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
9075 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
9080 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
9081 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
9083 \ifx\floattype\empty
9084 \let\safefloattype=
\empty
9087 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9088 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9091 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9095 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
9096 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9097 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
9098 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
9100 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno
\endcsname
9101 \global\advance\floatno by
1
9104 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
9105 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
9106 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
9107 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
9110 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=
\safefloattype}%
9111 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat
}%
9115 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
9118 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
9119 \restorefirstparagraphindent
9122 % we have these possibilities:
9123 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
9124 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
9125 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
9126 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
9127 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
9128 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
9129 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
9130 % @float & no caption:
9133 \let\floatident =
\empty
9135 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
9136 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
9138 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
9139 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9140 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
9141 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
9144 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9147 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
9148 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
9149 \let\captionline =
\floatident
9151 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
9152 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
9153 \appendtomacro\captionline{:
}% had ident, so need a colon between
9157 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
9160 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
9161 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
9162 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
9166 % Space below caption.
9170 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
9171 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
9172 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9173 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
9174 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
9175 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
9180 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
9181 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
9182 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
9184 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
9185 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
9192 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef
{\floatlabel-lof
}{\floatident
9193 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else :
\gtemp \fi}}%
9196 \egroup % end of \vtop
9198 % place the captured inserts
9200 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
9201 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
9202 % float. --kasal, 26may04
9207 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
9209 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
9210 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
9213 % @caption, @shortcaption
9215 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
9216 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
9217 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
9218 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
9220 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
9221 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
9224 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
9225 \csname newcount
\endcsname #1%
9227 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
9228 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
9229 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=
0 }%
9234 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
9235 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
9236 % first read the @float command.
9238 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie
\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9240 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
9241 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
9242 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!
}
9244 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
9245 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
9246 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
9248 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==
\finish}
9250 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
9251 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
9253 \def\doiffloat#1=
#2=
#3\finish{%
9255 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
9256 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
9259 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
9261 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
9262 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
9264 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9265 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9268 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9271 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
9272 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
9274 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
9275 \message{\linenumber No `
\safefloattype' floats to list.
}%
9279 \leftskip=
\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
9280 \let\do=
\listoffloatsdo
9281 \csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname
9286 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
9287 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
9288 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
9289 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
9291 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
9292 % they won't appear in the aux file).
9294 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
9295 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title
\finish{{%
9296 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
9297 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
9298 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
9300 \toksA =
\expandafter{\csname XR
#1-lof
\endcsname}%
9302 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
9303 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR
#1-pg
\endcsname}}%
9308 \message{localization,
}
9310 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
9311 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
9312 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
9315 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
9317 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
9318 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
9319 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
9320 \let_ =
\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test
9321 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
9323 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_
\finish
9325 \globaldefs =
1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9329 \endgroup % end raw TeX
9332 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
9335 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_
#2\finish{%
9336 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
9338 \errhelp =
\nolanghelp
9339 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-
#1.tex
}%
9341 \globaldefs =
1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9346 }% end of special _ catcode
9348 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
9349 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
9350 directory should work if nowhere else does.
}
9352 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
9353 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
9354 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
9356 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
9357 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
9358 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
9360 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
9361 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
9362 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
9363 % accented characters problem.)
9366 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
9367 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
9368 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@
#1\endcsname \relax
9369 \message{no patterns for
#1}%
9371 \global\language =
\csname lang@
#1\endcsname
9373 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
9374 \global\lefthyphenmin =
#2\relax
9375 \global\righthyphenmin =
#3\relax
9378 % Helpers for encodings.
9379 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
9381 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
9383 \loop\ifnum\count255<
256
9384 \global\catcode\count255=
#1\relax
9385 \advance\count255 by
1
9389 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
9391 \loop\ifnum\count255<
256
9392 \catcode\count255=
#1\relax
9393 \advance\count255 by
1
9397 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
9398 % according to the specified encoding.
9400 \def\documentencoding{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\documentencodingzzz}
9401 \def\documentencodingzzz#1{%
9402 % Encoding being declared for the document.
9403 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc
\endcsname}%
9405 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
9406 % to compare them with \ifx.
9407 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc
\endcsname}%
9408 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-
8859-
15.enc
\endcsname}%
9409 \def\latone{\csname ISO-
8859-
1.enc
\endcsname}%
9410 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-
8859-
2.enc
\endcsname}%
9411 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-
8.enc
\endcsname}%
9413 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
9416 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
9417 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9420 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
9421 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9424 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
9425 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9428 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
9429 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9430 % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
9431 % (below), do not re-invoke it, then our check for duplicated
9432 % definitions triggers. Making non-ascii chars active is enough.
9435 \message{Ignoring unknown
document encoding:
#1.
}%
9445 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
9446 % the default font encoding (OT1).
9448 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry:
#1.
}}
9450 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
9451 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,
{#1}\fi}
9453 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
9454 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
9455 % macros containing the character definitions.
9456 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9458 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
9459 \def\latonechardefs{%
9461 \gdef^^a1
{\exclamdown}
9462 \gdef^^a2
{{\tcfont \char162}} % cent
9464 \gdef^^a4
{{\tcfont \char164}} % currency
9465 \gdef^^a5
{{\tcfont \char165}} % yen
9466 \gdef^^a6
{{\tcfont \char166}} % broken bar
9469 \gdef^^a9
{\copyright}
9471 \gdef^^ab
{\guillemetleft}
9472 \gdef^^ac
{\ensuremath\lnot}
9474 \gdef^^ae
{\registeredsymbol}
9477 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
9484 \gdef^^b7
{\ensuremath\cdot}
9485 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
9488 \gdef^^bb
{\guillemetright}
9489 \gdef^^bc
{$
1\over4$
}
9490 \gdef^^bd
{$
1\over2$
}
9491 \gdef^^be
{$
3\over4$
}
9492 \gdef^^bf
{\questiondown}
9499 \gdef^^c5
{\ringaccent A
}
9501 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
9533 \gdef^^e5
{\ringaccent a
}
9535 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
9540 \gdef^^ec
{\`
{\dotless i
}}
9541 \gdef^^ed
{\'
{\dotless i
}}
9542 \gdef^^ee
{\^
{\dotless i
}}
9543 \gdef^^ef
{\"
{\dotless i
}}
9563 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
9564 \def\latninechardefs{%
9565 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
9578 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
9579 \def\lattwochardefs{%
9581 \gdef^^a1
{\ogonek{A
}}
9584 \gdef^^a4
{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN
}}
9590 \gdef^^aa
{\cedilla S
}
9595 \gdef^^af
{\dotaccent Z
}
9597 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
9598 \gdef^^b1
{\ogonek{a
}}
9599 \gdef^^b2
{\ogonek{ }}
9605 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
9607 \gdef^^ba
{\cedilla s
}
9612 \gdef^^bf
{\dotaccent z
}
9621 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
9624 \gdef^^ca
{\ogonek{E
}}
9640 \gdef^^d9
{\ringaccent U
}
9645 \gdef^^de
{\cedilla T
}
9655 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
9658 \gdef^^ea
{\ogonek{e
}}
9661 \gdef^^ed
{\'
{\dotless{i
}}}
9662 \gdef^^ee
{\^
{\dotless{i
}}}
9674 \gdef^^f9
{\ringaccent u
}
9679 \gdef^^fe
{\cedilla t
}
9680 \gdef^^ff
{\dotaccent{}}
9683 % UTF-8 character definitions.
9685 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
9686 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
9687 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
9693 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
9694 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\endcsname}
9696 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
9697 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
9699 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
9700 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
9702 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
9704 \message{\linenumber Unicode char
\string #1 not defined for Texinfo
}%
9715 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
9716 \uccode`\~
\countUTFx
9717 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
9718 \advance\countUTFx by
1
9719 \ifnum\countUTFx <
\countUTFy
9720 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
9726 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~
}}
9732 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~
}}
9738 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~
}}
9742 \def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
9744 % @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
9746 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:
#1\endcsname \relax
9747 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
9748 \errmessage{Unicode character U+
#1 not supported, sorry
}%
9750 \csname uni:
#1\endcsname
9762 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
9763 \countUTFz = "
#1\relax
9764 %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
9767 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets#
#1#
#2{%
9768 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\endcsname}%
9769 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3{%
9770 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\endcsname}%
9771 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
9772 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\string #
#4\endcsname}%
9773 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9774 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9775 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
9777 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:
#1\endcsname \relax \else
9778 \message{Internal error, already defined:
#1}%
9781 % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
9782 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:
#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
9785 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
9786 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0
\relax
9787 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
9788 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value <
00A0
}%
9789 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
800\relax
9791 \parseUTFviiiB C
\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,
%
9792 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
10000\relax
9795 \parseUTFviiiB E
\UTFviiiThreeOctets.
{,;
}%
9800 \parseUTFviiiB F
\UTFviiiFourOctets.
{!,;
}%
9804 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
9805 \countUTFx =
\countUTFz
9806 \divide\countUTFz by
64
9807 \countUTFy =
\countUTFz
9808 \multiply\countUTFz by
64
9809 \advance\countUTFx by -
\countUTFz
9810 \advance\countUTFx by
128
9811 \uccode `
#1\countUTFx
9812 \countUTFz =
\countUTFy}
9814 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
9815 \advance\countUTFz by "
#10\relax
9816 \uccode `
#3\countUTFz
9817 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
9820 % https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
9821 % U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
9822 % U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
9823 % U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
9824 % U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
9826 % Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
9827 % characters are available somewhere. Loading the necessary fonts
9828 % awaits user request. We can't truly support Unicode without
9829 % reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
9830 % plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
9831 % We won't be doing that here in this simple file. But we can try to at
9832 % least make most of the characters not bomb out.
9834 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
9835 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0
}{\tie}
9836 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1
}{\exclamdown}
9837 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A2
}{{\tcfont \char162}}% 0242=cent
9838 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3
}{\pounds}
9839 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A4
}{{\tcfont \char164}}% 0244=currency
9840 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A5
}{{\tcfont \char165}}% 0245=yen
9841 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A6
}{{\tcfont \char166}}% 0246=brokenbar
9842 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7
}{\S}
9843 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8
}{\"
{ }}
9844 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9
}{\copyright}
9845 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA
}{\ordf}
9846 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB
}{\guillemetleft}
9847 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC
}{\ensuremath\lnot}
9848 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD
}{\-
}
9849 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE
}{\registeredsymbol}
9850 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF
}{\=
{ }}
9852 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0
}{\ringaccent{ }}
9853 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1
}{\ensuremath\pm}
9854 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2
}{$^
2$
}
9855 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3
}{$^
3$
}
9856 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4
}{\'
{ }}
9857 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5
}{$
\mu$
}
9858 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6
}{\P}
9859 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7
}{\ensuremath\cdot}
9860 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8
}{\cedilla{ }}
9861 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9
}{$^
1$
}
9862 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA
}{\ordm}
9863 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB
}{\guillemetright}
9864 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC
}{$
1\over4$
}
9865 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD
}{$
1\over2$
}
9866 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE
}{$
3\over4$
}
9867 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF
}{\questiondown}
9869 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0
}{\`A
}
9870 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1
}{\'A
}
9871 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2
}{\^A
}
9872 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3
}{\~A
}
9873 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4
}{\"A
}
9874 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5
}{\AA}
9875 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6
}{\AE}
9876 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7
}{\cedilla{C
}}
9877 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8
}{\`E
}
9878 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9
}{\'E
}
9879 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA
}{\^E
}
9880 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB
}{\"E
}
9881 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC
}{\`I
}
9882 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD
}{\'I
}
9883 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE
}{\^I
}
9884 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF
}{\"I
}
9886 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0
}{\DH}
9887 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1
}{\~N
}
9888 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2
}{\`O
}
9889 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3
}{\'O
}
9890 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4
}{\^O
}
9891 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5
}{\~O
}
9892 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6
}{\"O
}
9893 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7
}{\ensuremath\times}
9894 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8
}{\O}
9895 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9
}{\`U
}
9896 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA
}{\'U
}
9897 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB
}{\^U
}
9898 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC
}{\"U
}
9899 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD
}{\'Y
}
9900 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE
}{\TH}
9901 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF
}{\ss}
9903 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0
}{\`a
}
9904 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1
}{\'a
}
9905 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2
}{\^a
}
9906 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3
}{\~a
}
9907 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4
}{\"a
}
9908 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5
}{\aa}
9909 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6
}{\ae}
9910 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7
}{\cedilla{c
}}
9911 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8
}{\`e
}
9912 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9
}{\'e
}
9913 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA
}{\^e
}
9914 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB
}{\"e
}
9915 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC
}{\`
{\dotless{i
}}}
9916 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED
}{\'
{\dotless{i
}}}
9917 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE
}{\^
{\dotless{i
}}}
9918 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF
}{\"
{\dotless{i
}}}
9920 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0
}{\dh}
9921 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1
}{\~n
}
9922 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2
}{\`o
}
9923 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3
}{\'o
}
9924 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4
}{\^o
}
9925 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5
}{\~o
}
9926 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6
}{\"o
}
9927 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7
}{\ensuremath\div}
9928 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8
}{\o}
9929 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9
}{\`u
}
9930 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA
}{\'u
}
9931 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB
}{\^u
}
9932 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC
}{\"u
}
9933 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD
}{\'y
}
9934 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE
}{\th}
9935 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF
}{\"y
}
9937 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A
}
9938 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a
}
9939 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A
}}
9940 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a
}}
9941 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A
}}
9942 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a
}}
9943 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C
}
9944 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c
}
9945 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C
}
9946 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c
}
9947 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A
}{\dotaccent{C
}}
9948 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B
}{\dotaccent{c
}}
9949 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C
}{\v{C
}}
9950 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D
}{\v{c
}}
9951 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E
}{\v{D
}}
9952 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F
}{d'
}
9954 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}
9955 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}
9956 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E
}
9957 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e
}
9958 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E
}}
9959 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e
}}
9960 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E
}}
9961 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e
}}
9962 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E
}}
9963 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e
}}
9964 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A
}{\v{E
}}
9965 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B
}{\v{e
}}
9966 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C
}{\^G
}
9967 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D
}{\^g
}
9968 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E
}{\u{G
}}
9969 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F
}{\u{g
}}
9971 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G
}}
9972 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g
}}
9973 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G
}}
9974 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g
}}
9975 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H
}
9976 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h
}
9977 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE
}}
9978 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE
}}
9979 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I
}
9980 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~
{\dotless{i
}}}
9981 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A
}{\=I
}
9982 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B
}{\=
{\dotless{i
}}}
9983 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C
}{\u{I
}}
9984 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D
}{\u{\dotless{i
}}}
9985 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E
}{\ogonek{I
}}
9986 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F
}{\ogonek{i
}}
9988 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I
}}
9989 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i
}}
9990 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ
}
9991 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij
}
9992 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J
}
9993 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^
{\dotless{j
}}}
9994 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K
}}
9995 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k
}}
9996 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}
9997 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L
}
9998 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A
}{\'l
}
9999 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B
}{\cedilla{L
}}
10000 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C
}{\cedilla{l
}}
10001 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D
}{L'
}% should kern
10002 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E
}{l'
}% should kern
10003 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F
}{L
\U{00B7
}}
10005 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l
\U{00B7
}}
10006 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
10007 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
10008 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N
}
10009 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n
}
10010 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N
}}
10011 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n
}}
10012 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N
}}
10013 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n
}}
10014 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n
}
10015 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A
}{\missingcharmsg{ENG
}}
10016 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B
}{\missingcharmsg{eng
}}
10017 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C
}{\=O
}
10018 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D
}{\=o
}
10019 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E
}{\u{O
}}
10020 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F
}{\u{o
}}
10022 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O
}}
10023 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o
}}
10024 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
10025 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
10026 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R
}
10027 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r
}
10028 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R
}}
10029 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r
}}
10030 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R
}}
10031 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r
}}
10032 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A
}{\'S
}
10033 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B
}{\'s
}
10034 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C
}{\^S
}
10035 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D
}{\^s
}
10036 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E
}{\cedilla{S
}}
10037 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F
}{\cedilla{s
}}
10039 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S
}}
10040 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s
}}
10041 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T
}}
10042 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t
}}
10043 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T
}}
10044 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t
}}
10045 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE
}}
10046 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE
}}
10047 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U
}
10048 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u
}
10049 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A
}{\=U
}
10050 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B
}{\=u
}
10051 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C
}{\u{U
}}
10052 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D
}{\u{u
}}
10053 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E
}{\ringaccent{U
}}
10054 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F
}{\ringaccent{u
}}
10056 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U
}}
10057 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u
}}
10058 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U
}}
10059 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u
}}
10060 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W
}
10061 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w
}
10062 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y
}
10063 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y
}
10064 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y
}
10065 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z
}
10066 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A
}{\'z
}
10067 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B
}{\dotaccent{Z
}}
10068 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C
}{\dotaccent{z
}}
10069 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D
}{\v{Z
}}
10070 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E
}{\v{z
}}
10071 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F
}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S
}}
10073 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4
}{D
\v{Z
}}
10074 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5
}{D
\v{z
}}
10075 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6
}{d
\v{z
}}
10076 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7
}{LJ
}
10077 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8
}{Lj
}
10078 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9
}{lj
}
10079 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA
}{NJ
}
10080 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB
}{Nj
}
10081 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC
}{nj
}
10082 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD
}{\v{A
}}
10083 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE
}{\v{a
}}
10084 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF
}{\v{I
}}
10086 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0
}{\v{\dotless{i
}}}
10087 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1
}{\v{O
}}
10088 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2
}{\v{o
}}
10089 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3
}{\v{U
}}
10090 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4
}{\v{u
}}
10092 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2
}{\=
{\AE}}
10093 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3
}{\=
{\ae}}
10094 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6
}{\v{G
}}
10095 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7
}{\v{g
}}
10096 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8
}{\v{K
}}
10097 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9
}{\v{k
}}
10099 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0
}{\v{\dotless{j
}}}
10100 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1
}{DZ
}
10101 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2
}{Dz
}
10102 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3
}{dz
}
10103 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4
}{\'G
}
10104 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5
}{\'g
}
10105 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8
}{\`N
}
10106 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9
}{\`n
}
10107 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC
}{\'
{\AE}}
10108 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD
}{\'
{\ae}}
10109 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE
}{\'
{\O}}
10110 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF
}{\'
{\o}}
10112 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E
}{\v{H
}}
10113 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F
}{\v{h
}}
10115 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A
}}
10116 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a
}}
10117 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E
}}
10118 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e
}}
10119 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E
}{\dotaccent{O
}}
10120 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F
}{\dotaccent{o
}}
10122 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y
}
10123 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y
}
10124 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j
}}
10126 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB
}{\ogonek{ }}
10128 % Greek letters upper case
10129 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0391}{{\it A
}}
10130 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0392}{{\it B
}}
10131 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0393}{\ensuremath{\mit\Gamma}}
10132 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0394}{\ensuremath{\mit\Delta}}
10133 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0395}{{\it E
}}
10134 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0396}{{\it Z
}}
10135 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0397}{{\it H
}}
10136 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0398}{\ensuremath{\mit\Theta}}
10137 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0399}{{\it I
}}
10138 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039A
}{{\it K
}}
10139 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039B
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Lambda}}
10140 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039C
}{{\it M
}}
10141 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039D
}{{\it N
}}
10142 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039E
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Xi}}
10143 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039F
}{{\it O
}}
10144 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A0
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Pi}}
10145 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A1
}{{\it P
}}
10146 %\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A2}{} % none - corresponds to final sigma
10147 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A3
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Sigma}}
10148 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A4
}{{\it T
}}
10149 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A5
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Upsilon}}
10150 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A6
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Phi}}
10151 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A7
}{{\it X
}}
10152 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A8
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Psi}}
10153 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A9
}{\ensuremath{\mit\Omega}}
10155 % Vowels with accents
10156 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0390}{\ensuremath{\ddot{\acute\iota}}}
10157 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AC
}{\ensuremath{\acute\alpha}}
10158 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AD
}{\ensuremath{\acute\epsilon}}
10159 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AE
}{\ensuremath{\acute\eta}}
10160 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AF
}{\ensuremath{\acute\iota}}
10161 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B0
}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ddot\upsilon}}}
10163 % Standalone accent
10164 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0384}{\ensuremath{\acute{\
}}}
10166 % Greek letters lower case
10167 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B1
}{\ensuremath\alpha}
10168 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B2
}{\ensuremath\beta}
10169 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B3
}{\ensuremath\gamma}
10170 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B4
}{\ensuremath\delta}
10171 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B5
}{\ensuremath\epsilon}
10172 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B6
}{\ensuremath\zeta}
10173 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B7
}{\ensuremath\eta}
10174 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B8
}{\ensuremath\theta}
10175 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B9
}{\ensuremath\iota}
10176 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BA
}{\ensuremath\kappa}
10177 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BB
}{\ensuremath\lambda}
10178 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BC
}{\ensuremath\mu}
10179 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BD
}{\ensuremath\nu}
10180 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BE
}{\ensuremath\xi}
10181 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BF
}{{\it o
}} % omicron
10182 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C0
}{\ensuremath\pi}
10183 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C1
}{\ensuremath\rho}
10184 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C2
}{\ensuremath\varsigma}
10185 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C3
}{\ensuremath\sigma}
10186 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C4
}{\ensuremath\tau}
10187 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C5
}{\ensuremath\upsilon}
10188 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C6
}{\ensuremath\phi}
10189 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C7
}{\ensuremath\chi}
10190 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C8
}{\ensuremath\psi}
10191 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C9
}{\ensuremath\omega}
10193 % More Greek vowels with accents
10194 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CA
}{\ensuremath{\ddot\iota}}
10195 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CB
}{\ensuremath{\ddot\upsilon}}
10196 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CC
}{\ensuremath{\acute o
}}
10197 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CD
}{\ensuremath{\acute\upsilon}}
10198 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CE
}{\ensuremath{\acute\omega}}
10200 % Variant Greek letters
10201 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D1
}{\ensuremath\vartheta}
10202 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D6
}{\ensuremath\varpi}
10203 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03F1
}{\ensuremath\varrho}
10205 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02
}{\dotaccent{B
}}
10206 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03
}{\dotaccent{b
}}
10207 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04
}{\udotaccent{B
}}
10208 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05
}{\udotaccent{b
}}
10209 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06
}{\ubaraccent{B
}}
10210 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07
}{\ubaraccent{b
}}
10211 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A
}{\dotaccent{D
}}
10212 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B
}{\dotaccent{d
}}
10213 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C
}{\udotaccent{D
}}
10214 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D
}{\udotaccent{d
}}
10215 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E
}{\ubaraccent{D
}}
10216 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F
}{\ubaraccent{d
}}
10218 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E
}{\dotaccent{F
}}
10219 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F
}{\dotaccent{f
}}
10221 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20
}{\=G
}
10222 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21
}{\=g
}
10223 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22
}{\dotaccent{H
}}
10224 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23
}{\dotaccent{h
}}
10225 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24
}{\udotaccent{H
}}
10226 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25
}{\udotaccent{h
}}
10227 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26
}{\"H
}
10228 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27
}{\"h
}
10230 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30
}{\'K
}
10231 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31
}{\'k
}
10232 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32
}{\udotaccent{K
}}
10233 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33
}{\udotaccent{k
}}
10234 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34
}{\ubaraccent{K
}}
10235 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35
}{\ubaraccent{k
}}
10236 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36
}{\udotaccent{L
}}
10237 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37
}{\udotaccent{l
}}
10238 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A
}{\ubaraccent{L
}}
10239 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B
}{\ubaraccent{l
}}
10240 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E
}{\'M
}
10241 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F
}{\'m
}
10243 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40
}{\dotaccent{M
}}
10244 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41
}{\dotaccent{m
}}
10245 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42
}{\udotaccent{M
}}
10246 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43
}{\udotaccent{m
}}
10247 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44
}{\dotaccent{N
}}
10248 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45
}{\dotaccent{n
}}
10249 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46
}{\udotaccent{N
}}
10250 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47
}{\udotaccent{n
}}
10251 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48
}{\ubaraccent{N
}}
10252 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49
}{\ubaraccent{n
}}
10254 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54
}{\'P
}
10255 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55
}{\'p
}
10256 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56
}{\dotaccent{P
}}
10257 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57
}{\dotaccent{p
}}
10258 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58
}{\dotaccent{R
}}
10259 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59
}{\dotaccent{r
}}
10260 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A
}{\udotaccent{R
}}
10261 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B
}{\udotaccent{r
}}
10262 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E
}{\ubaraccent{R
}}
10263 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F
}{\ubaraccent{r
}}
10265 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60
}{\dotaccent{S
}}
10266 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61
}{\dotaccent{s
}}
10267 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62
}{\udotaccent{S
}}
10268 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63
}{\udotaccent{s
}}
10269 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A
}{\dotaccent{T
}}
10270 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B
}{\dotaccent{t
}}
10271 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C
}{\udotaccent{T
}}
10272 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D
}{\udotaccent{t
}}
10273 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E
}{\ubaraccent{T
}}
10274 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F
}{\ubaraccent{t
}}
10276 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C
}{\~V
}
10277 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D
}{\~v
}
10278 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E
}{\udotaccent{V
}}
10279 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F
}{\udotaccent{v
}}
10281 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80
}{\`W
}
10282 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81
}{\`w
}
10283 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82
}{\'W
}
10284 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83
}{\'w
}
10285 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84
}{\"W
}
10286 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85
}{\"w
}
10287 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86
}{\dotaccent{W
}}
10288 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87
}{\dotaccent{w
}}
10289 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88
}{\udotaccent{W
}}
10290 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89
}{\udotaccent{w
}}
10291 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A
}{\dotaccent{X
}}
10292 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B
}{\dotaccent{x
}}
10293 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C
}{\"X
}
10294 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D
}{\"x
}
10295 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E
}{\dotaccent{Y
}}
10296 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F
}{\dotaccent{y
}}
10298 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90
}{\^Z
}
10299 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91
}{\^z
}
10300 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92
}{\udotaccent{Z
}}
10301 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93
}{\udotaccent{z
}}
10302 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94
}{\ubaraccent{Z
}}
10303 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95
}{\ubaraccent{z
}}
10304 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96
}{\ubaraccent{h
}}
10305 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97
}{\"t
}
10306 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98
}{\ringaccent{w
}}
10307 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99
}{\ringaccent{y
}}
10309 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0
}{\udotaccent{A
}}
10310 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1
}{\udotaccent{a
}}
10312 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8
}{\udotaccent{E
}}
10313 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9
}{\udotaccent{e
}}
10314 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC
}{\~E
}
10315 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD
}{\~e
}
10317 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA
}{\udotaccent{I
}}
10318 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB
}{\udotaccent{i
}}
10319 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC
}{\udotaccent{O
}}
10320 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD
}{\udotaccent{o
}}
10322 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4
}{\udotaccent{U
}}
10323 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5
}{\udotaccent{u
}}
10325 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2
}{\`Y
}
10326 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3
}{\`y
}
10327 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4
}{\udotaccent{Y
}}
10329 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8
}{\~Y
}
10330 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9
}{\~y
}
10333 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--
}
10334 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---
}
10335 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
10336 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
10337 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A
}{\quotesinglbase}
10338 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C
}{\quotedblleft}
10339 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D
}{\quotedblright}
10340 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E
}{\quotedblbase}
10341 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}
10342 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}
10343 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
10344 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{202F
}{\thinspace}
10345 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
10346 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
10347 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A
}{\guilsinglright}
10349 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC
}{\euro}
10351 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
10352 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2
}{\result}
10354 % Mathematical symbols
10355 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2200}{\ensuremath\forall}
10356 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2203}{\ensuremath\exists}
10357 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2208}{\ensuremath\in}
10358 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
10359 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\ast}
10360 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221E
}{\ensuremath\infty}
10361 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}
10362 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2227}{\ensuremath\wedge}
10363 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2229}{\ensuremath\cap}
10364 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
10365 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2264}{\ensuremath\leq}
10366 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2265}{\ensuremath\geq}
10367 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2282}{\ensuremath\subset}
10368 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2287}{\ensuremath\supseteq}
10370 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2016}{\ensuremath\Vert}
10371 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2032}{\ensuremath\prime}
10372 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{210F
}{\ensuremath\hbar}
10373 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2111}{\ensuremath\Im}
10374 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2113}{\ensuremath\ell}
10375 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2118}{\ensuremath\wp}
10376 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{211C
}{\ensuremath\Re}
10377 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2127}{\ensuremath\mho}
10378 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2135}{\ensuremath\aleph}
10379 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2190}{\ensuremath\leftarrow}
10380 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2191}{\ensuremath\uparrow}
10381 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2193}{\ensuremath\downarrow}
10382 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2194}{\ensuremath\leftrightarrow}
10383 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2195}{\ensuremath\updownarrow}
10384 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2196}{\ensuremath\nwarrow}
10385 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2197}{\ensuremath\nearrow}
10386 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2198}{\ensuremath\searrow}
10387 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2199}{\ensuremath\swarrow}
10388 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A6
}{\ensuremath\mapsto}
10389 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A9
}{\ensuremath\hookleftarrow}
10390 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21AA
}{\ensuremath\hookrightarrow}
10391 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BC
}{\ensuremath\leftharpoonup}
10392 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BD
}{\ensuremath\leftharpoondown}
10393 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BE
}{\ensuremath\upharpoonright}
10394 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C0
}{\ensuremath\rightharpoonup}
10395 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C1
}{\ensuremath\rightharpoondown}
10396 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21CC
}{\ensuremath\rightleftharpoons}
10397 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D0
}{\ensuremath\Leftarrow}
10398 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D1
}{\ensuremath\Uparrow}
10399 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D3
}{\ensuremath\Downarrow}
10400 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D4
}{\ensuremath\Leftrightarrow}
10401 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D5
}{\ensuremath\Updownarrow}
10402 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21DD
}{\ensuremath\leadsto}
10403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2201}{\ensuremath\complement}
10404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2202}{\ensuremath\partial}
10405 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2205}{\ensuremath\emptyset}
10406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2207}{\ensuremath\nabla}
10407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2209}{\ensuremath\notin}
10408 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220B
}{\ensuremath\owns}
10409 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220F
}{\ensuremath\prod}
10410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2210}{\ensuremath\coprod}
10411 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2211}{\ensuremath\sum}
10412 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2213}{\ensuremath\mp}
10413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2218}{\ensuremath\circ}
10414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221A
}{\ensuremath\surd}
10415 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221D
}{\ensuremath\propto}
10416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2220}{\ensuremath\angle}
10417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2223}{\ensuremath\mid}
10418 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2228}{\ensuremath\vee}
10419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222A
}{\ensuremath\cup}
10420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222B
}{\ensuremath\smallint}
10421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222E
}{\ensuremath\oint}
10422 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{223C
}{\ensuremath\sim}
10423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2240}{\ensuremath\wr}
10424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2243}{\ensuremath\simeq}
10425 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2245}{\ensuremath\cong}
10426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2248}{\ensuremath\approx}
10427 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{224D
}{\ensuremath\asymp}
10428 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2250}{\ensuremath\doteq}
10429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2260}{\ensuremath\neq}
10430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226A
}{\ensuremath\ll}
10431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226B
}{\ensuremath\gg}
10432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227A
}{\ensuremath\prec}
10433 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227B
}{\ensuremath\succ}
10434 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2283}{\ensuremath\supset}
10435 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2286}{\ensuremath\subseteq}
10436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228E
}{\ensuremath\uplus}
10437 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228F
}{\ensuremath\sqsubset}
10438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2290}{\ensuremath\sqsupset}
10439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2291}{\ensuremath\sqsubseteq}
10440 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2292}{\ensuremath\sqsupseteq}
10441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2293}{\ensuremath\sqcap}
10442 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2294}{\ensuremath\sqcup}
10443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2295}{\ensuremath\oplus}
10444 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2296}{\ensuremath\ominus}
10445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2297}{\ensuremath\otimes}
10446 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2298}{\ensuremath\oslash}
10447 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2299}{\ensuremath\odot}
10448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A2
}{\ensuremath\vdash}
10449 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A3
}{\ensuremath\dashv}
10450 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A4
}{\ensuremath\ptextop}
10451 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A5
}{\ensuremath\bot}
10452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A8
}{\ensuremath\models}
10453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22B4
}{\ensuremath\unlhd}
10454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22B5
}{\ensuremath\unrhd}
10455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C0
}{\ensuremath\bigwedge}
10456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C1
}{\ensuremath\bigvee}
10457 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C2
}{\ensuremath\bigcap}
10458 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C3
}{\ensuremath\bigcup}
10459 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C4
}{\ensuremath\diamond}
10460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C5
}{\ensuremath\cdot}
10461 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C6
}{\ensuremath\star}
10462 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C8
}{\ensuremath\bowtie}
10463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2308}{\ensuremath\lceil}
10464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2309}{\ensuremath\rceil}
10465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230A
}{\ensuremath\lfloor}
10466 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230B
}{\ensuremath\rfloor}
10467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2322}{\ensuremath\frown}
10468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2323}{\ensuremath\smile}
10470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25A1
}{\ensuremath\Box}
10471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B3
}{\ensuremath\triangle}
10472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B7
}{\ensuremath\triangleright}
10473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25BD
}{\ensuremath\bigtriangledown}
10474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C1
}{\ensuremath\triangleleft}
10475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C7
}{\ensuremath\Diamond}
10476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2660}{\ensuremath\spadesuit}
10477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2661}{\ensuremath\heartsuit}
10478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2662}{\ensuremath\diamondsuit}
10479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2663}{\ensuremath\clubsuit}
10480 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266D
}{\ensuremath\flat}
10481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266E
}{\ensuremath\natural}
10482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266F
}{\ensuremath\sharp}
10483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{26AA
}{\ensuremath\bigcirc}
10484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27B9
}{\ensuremath\rangle}
10485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27C2
}{\ensuremath\perp}
10486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27E8
}{\ensuremath\langle}
10487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F5
}{\ensuremath\longleftarrow}
10488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F6
}{\ensuremath\longrightarrow}
10489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F7
}{\ensuremath\longleftrightarrow}
10490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27FC
}{\ensuremath\longmapsto}
10491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{29F5
}{\ensuremath\setminus}
10492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A00
}{\ensuremath\bigodot}
10493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A01
}{\ensuremath\bigoplus}
10494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A02
}{\ensuremath\bigotimes}
10495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A04
}{\ensuremath\biguplus}
10496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A06
}{\ensuremath\bigsqcup}
10497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A1D
}{\ensuremath\Join}
10498 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A3F
}{\ensuremath\amalg}
10499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AAF
}{\ensuremath\preceq}
10500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AB0
}{\ensuremath\succeq}
10502 \global\mathchardef\checkmark="
1370 % actually the square root sign
10503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2713}{\ensuremath\checkmark}
10504 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
10506 % US-ASCII character definitions.
10507 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
10511 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
10512 \def\nonasciistringdefs{%
10513 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
10514 \def\defstringchar#
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1}}%
10516 \defstringchar^^
80\defstringchar^^
81\defstringchar^^
82\defstringchar^^
83%
10517 \defstringchar^^
84\defstringchar^^
85\defstringchar^^
86\defstringchar^^
87%
10518 \defstringchar^^
88\defstringchar^^
89\defstringchar^^
8a
\defstringchar^^
8b
%
10519 \defstringchar^^
8c
\defstringchar^^
8d
\defstringchar^^
8e
\defstringchar^^
8f
%
10521 \defstringchar^^
90\defstringchar^^
91\defstringchar^^
92\defstringchar^^
93%
10522 \defstringchar^^
94\defstringchar^^
95\defstringchar^^
96\defstringchar^^
97%
10523 \defstringchar^^
98\defstringchar^^
99\defstringchar^^
9a
\defstringchar^^
9b
%
10524 \defstringchar^^
9c
\defstringchar^^
9d
\defstringchar^^
9e
\defstringchar^^
9f
%
10526 \defstringchar^^a0
\defstringchar^^a1
\defstringchar^^a2
\defstringchar^^a3
%
10527 \defstringchar^^a4
\defstringchar^^a5
\defstringchar^^a6
\defstringchar^^a7
%
10528 \defstringchar^^a8
\defstringchar^^a9
\defstringchar^^aa
\defstringchar^^ab
%
10529 \defstringchar^^ac
\defstringchar^^ad
\defstringchar^^ae
\defstringchar^^af
%
10531 \defstringchar^^b0
\defstringchar^^b1
\defstringchar^^b2
\defstringchar^^b3
%
10532 \defstringchar^^b4
\defstringchar^^b5
\defstringchar^^b6
\defstringchar^^b7
%
10533 \defstringchar^^b8
\defstringchar^^b9
\defstringchar^^ba
\defstringchar^^bb
%
10534 \defstringchar^^bc
\defstringchar^^bd
\defstringchar^^be
\defstringchar^^bf
%
10536 \defstringchar^^c0
\defstringchar^^c1
\defstringchar^^c2
\defstringchar^^c3
%
10537 \defstringchar^^c4
\defstringchar^^c5
\defstringchar^^c6
\defstringchar^^c7
%
10538 \defstringchar^^c8
\defstringchar^^c9
\defstringchar^^ca
\defstringchar^^cb
%
10539 \defstringchar^^cc
\defstringchar^^cd
\defstringchar^^ce
\defstringchar^^cf
%
10541 \defstringchar^^d0
\defstringchar^^d1
\defstringchar^^d2
\defstringchar^^d3
%
10542 \defstringchar^^d4
\defstringchar^^d5
\defstringchar^^d6
\defstringchar^^d7
%
10543 \defstringchar^^d8
\defstringchar^^d9
\defstringchar^^da
\defstringchar^^db
%
10544 \defstringchar^^dc
\defstringchar^^dd
\defstringchar^^de
\defstringchar^^df
%
10546 \defstringchar^^e0
\defstringchar^^e1
\defstringchar^^e2
\defstringchar^^e3
%
10547 \defstringchar^^e4
\defstringchar^^e5
\defstringchar^^e6
\defstringchar^^e7
%
10548 \defstringchar^^e8
\defstringchar^^e9
\defstringchar^^ea
\defstringchar^^eb
%
10549 \defstringchar^^ec
\defstringchar^^ed
\defstringchar^^ee
\defstringchar^^ef
%
10551 \defstringchar^^f0
\defstringchar^^f1
\defstringchar^^f2
\defstringchar^^f3
%
10552 \defstringchar^^f4
\defstringchar^^f5
\defstringchar^^f6
\defstringchar^^f7
%
10553 \defstringchar^^f8
\defstringchar^^f9
\defstringchar^^fa
\defstringchar^^fb
%
10554 \defstringchar^^fc
\defstringchar^^fd
\defstringchar^^fe
\defstringchar^^ff
%
10558 % define all the unicode characters we know about, for the sake of @U.
10562 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
10563 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
10564 % document encoding.
10566 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
10569 \message{formatting,
}
10571 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent =
15pt
10573 \chapheadingskip =
15pt plus
4pt minus
2pt
10574 \secheadingskip =
12pt plus
3pt minus
2pt
10575 \subsecheadingskip =
9pt plus
2pt minus
2pt
10577 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
10580 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
10583 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
10584 \widowpenalty=
10000
10587 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
10588 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
10589 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
10590 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
10592 \def\setemergencystretch{%
10593 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
10594 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
10595 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
10597 \emergencystretch =
.15\hsize
10601 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
10602 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
10603 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
10605 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
10606 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
10608 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
10609 \voffset =
#3\relax
10610 \topskip =
#6\relax
10611 \splittopskip =
\topskip
10614 \advance\vsize by
\topskip
10615 \outervsize =
\vsize
10616 \advance\outervsize by
2\topandbottommargin
10617 \pageheight =
\vsize
10620 \outerhsize =
\hsize
10621 \advance\outerhsize by
0.5in
10622 \pagewidth =
\hsize
10624 \normaloffset =
#4\relax
10625 \bindingoffset =
#5\relax
10628 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
10629 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
10630 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
10631 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
10632 \pdfhorigin =
1 true in
10633 \pdfvorigin =
1 true in
10636 \setleading{\textleading}
10638 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
10639 \setemergencystretch
10642 % @letterpaper (the default).
10643 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
10644 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
10645 \textleading =
13.2pt
10647 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
10648 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt
}{6in
}% that's 46 lines
10650 {\bindingoffset}{36pt
}%
10654 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
10655 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs =
1
10656 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt
10657 \textleading =
12pt
10659 \internalpagesizes{7.5in
}{5in
}%
10661 {\bindingoffset}{16pt
}%
10664 \lispnarrowing =
0.3in
10667 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
10668 \defbodyindent =
.5cm
10671 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
10672 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
10673 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs =
1
10674 \parskip =
1.5pt plus
1pt
10675 \textleading =
12pt
10677 \internalpagesizes{7.4in
}{4.8in
}%
10682 \lispnarrowing =
0.25in
10685 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
10686 \defbodyindent =
.4cm
10689 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
10690 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
10691 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
10692 \textleading =
13.2pt
10694 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
10695 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
10696 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
10697 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
10698 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
10699 % your texinfo source file like this:
10701 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
10702 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
10704 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt
}{160mm
}% that's 51 lines
10705 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
10706 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
10711 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
10712 \defbodyindent =
5mm
10715 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
10716 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
10717 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
10718 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs =
1
10719 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt minus
0.1pt
10720 \textleading =
12.5pt
10722 \internalpagesizes{160mm
}{120mm
}%
10723 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
10724 {\bindingoffset}{8pt
}%
10727 \lispnarrowing =
0.2in
10730 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
10731 \defbodyindent =
2mm
10732 \tableindent =
12mm
10735 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
10736 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs =
1
10738 \internalpagesizes{237mm
}{150mm
}%
10740 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
10743 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
10747 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
10748 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs =
1
10750 \internalpagesizes{241mm
}{165mm
}%
10751 {\voffset}{-
2.95mm
}%
10752 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
10757 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
10758 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
10759 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
10761 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,
\finish}
10762 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,
#2,
#3\finish{{%
10763 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\hsize=
#2\relax \fi
10766 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
10767 \setleading{\textleading}%
10770 \advance\dimen0 by
\voffset
10773 \advance\dimen2 by
\normaloffset
10775 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
10776 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
10777 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
10778 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
10781 % Set default to letter.
10786 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.
}
10788 \def^^L
{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
10790 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
10793 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
10794 \catcode`\"=
\other \def\normaldoublequote{"
}
10795 \catcode`\$=
\other \def\normaldollar{$
}%$ font-lock fix
10796 \catcode`\+=
\other \def\normalplus{+
}
10797 \catcode`\<=
\other \def\normalless{<
}
10798 \catcode`\>=
\other \def\normalgreater{>
}
10799 \catcode`\^=
\other \def\normalcaret{^
}
10800 \catcode`
\_=
\other \def\normalunderscore{_
}
10801 \catcode`\|=
\other \def\normalverticalbar{|
}
10802 \catcode`\~=
\other \def\normaltilde{~
}
10804 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
10805 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
10806 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
10808 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
10809 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
10810 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
10811 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
10813 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
10815 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
10816 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
10817 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
10818 % this is not a problem.
10819 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
10821 % Turn off all special characters except @
10822 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
10823 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
10824 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
10826 \catcode`\"=
\active
10827 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
10828 \let"=
\activedoublequote
10829 \catcode`\~=
\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ =
\activetilde
10830 \chardef\hatchar=`\^
10831 \catcode`\^=
\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hatchar}} \let^ =
\activehat
10833 \catcode`
\_=
\active
10834 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
10836 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
10837 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em
\vbox{\hrule width
.3em height
.1ex
}\kern .07em
}
10839 \catcode`\|=
\active
10840 \def|
{{\tt\char124}}
10843 \catcode`\<=
\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< =
\activeless
10845 \catcode`\>=
\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> =
\activegtr
10846 \catcode`\+=
\active \def+
{{\tt \char 43}}
10847 \catcode`\$=
\active \def$
{\ifusingit{{\sl\$
}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
10848 \catcode`\-=
\active \let-=
\normaldash
10851 % used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
10852 % breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
10853 \def\texinfochars{%
10854 \let< =
\activeless
10856 \let~ =
\activetilde
10858 \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
10860 \let\i =
\smartitalic
10861 % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
10864 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
10866 \def\turnoffactive{%
10867 \normalturnoffactive
10873 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
10875 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
10876 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=
\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
10878 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
10879 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
10880 {\catcode`\\=
\other @gdef@realbackslash
{\
} @gdef@doublebackslash
{\\
}}
10882 % In Texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
10883 % in fixed width font.
10884 \catcode`\\=
\active % @ for escape char from now on.
10886 % Print a typewriter backslash. For math mode, we can't simply use
10887 % \backslashcurfont: the story here is that in math mode, the \char
10888 % of \backslashcurfont ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol
10889 % font (because \char in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex
10890 % sets \mathcode`\\="026E). Hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
10891 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
10892 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
10893 % usual hex value because it has already been made active.
10895 @def@ttbackslash
{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi
}}
10896 @let@backslashchar = @ttbackslash
% @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
10898 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
10899 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
10900 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
10901 @gdef@rawbackslash
{@let\=@backslashcurfont
}
10902 @gdef@otherbackslash
{@let\=@realbackslash
}
10904 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
10905 % the literal character `\'.
10907 {@catcode`- = @active
10908 @gdef@normalturnoffactive
{%
10909 @nonasciistringdefs
10911 @let"=@normaldoublequote
10912 @let$=@normaldollar
%$ font-lock fix
10915 @let>=@normalgreater
10917 @let_=@normalunderscore
10918 @let|=@normalverticalbar
10921 @markupsetuplqdefault
10922 @markupsetuprqdefault
10927 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
10928 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
10929 % So turn them off again, and have @fixbackslash turn them back on.
10930 @catcode`+=@other @catcode`@_=@other
10932 % \enablebackslashhack - allow file to begin `\input texinfo'
10934 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
10935 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
10937 % If the file did not have a `\input texinfo', then it is turned off after
10938 % the first line; otherwise the first `\' in the file would cause an error.
10939 % This is used on the very last line of this file, texinfo.tex.
10940 % We also use @c to call @fixbackslash, in case ends of lines are hidden.
10943 @catcode`@^^M=
13@gdef@enablebackslashhack
{%
10944 @global@let\ = @eatinput
%
10946 @def@c
{@fixbackslash@c
}%
10947 @def ^^M
{@let^^M@secondlinenl
}%
10948 @gdef @secondlinenl
{@let^^M@thirdlinenl
}%
10949 @gdef @thirdlinenl
{@fixbackslash
}%
10952 {@catcode`@^=
7 @catcode`@^^M=
13%
10953 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo
#1^^M
{@fixbackslash
}}
10955 @gdef@fixbackslash
{%
10956 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @ttbackslash @fi
10957 @catcode13=
5 % regular end of line
10959 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
10960 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
10962 @catcode`@_=@active
10964 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
10965 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. This macro, @fixbackslash, gets
10966 % called at the beginning of every Texinfo file. Not opening texinfo.cnf
10967 % directly in this file, texinfo.tex, makes it possible to make a format
10968 % file for Texinfo.
10970 @openin
1 texinfo.cnf
10971 @ifeof
1 @else @input texinfo.cnf @fi
10976 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
10979 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
10980 % active definitions as the normal characters.
10982 @def@normalquest
{?
}
10983 @def@normalslash
{/
}
10985 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
10986 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
10987 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp
{&
}
10988 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash
{#
}
10989 @catcode`@
% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
10991 @let @hashchar = @normalhash
10993 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
10994 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w
{@code
{`foo'
}}. If we
10995 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
10996 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
10997 @catcode`@'=@active
10998 @catcode`@`=@active
10999 @markupsetuplqdefault
11000 @markupsetuprqdefault
11002 @c Local variables:
11003 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
11004 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\
\message\\|emacs-page"
11005 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\
\texinfoversion{"
11006 @c time-stamp-format: "
%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
11007 @c time-stamp-end: "
}"
11013 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-
0b2efa2ea115
11015 @enablebackslashhack